]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
* gdbint.texinfo (User Interface): A new section about ui_out
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
e9c75b65 34@set DATE April 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
129
130* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
131
132* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
133* Altering:: Altering execution
134* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
135* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
136* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
137* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
138* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
139* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
140* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 141* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
142
143* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
144* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
145
146* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
147* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
148* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
149* Index:: Index
150@end menu
151
b9deaee7 152@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
153
154@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
155
156@ifhtml
157@node Top
158
159@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
160
161This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
162
163This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
164@value{GDBVN}.
165
166Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
167
c906108c
SS
168@menu
169* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 170* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
171
172* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
173* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
174* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
175* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
176* Stack:: Examining the stack
177* Source:: Examining source files
178* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 179
7a292a7a 180* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
181
182* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
183* Altering:: Altering execution
184* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
185* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 186* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
187* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
188* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 189* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 190* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
191
192* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 193* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
194
195* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
196* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
197* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
198* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
199@end menu
200
6d2ebf8b
SS
201@end ifhtml
202
449f3b6c
AC
203@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
204@iftex
205@contents
206@end iftex
207
6d2ebf8b 208@node Summary
c906108c
SS
209@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
210
211The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
212going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
213program was doing at the moment it crashed.
214
215@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
216these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
217
218@itemize @bullet
219@item
220Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
221
222@item
223Make your program stop on specified conditions.
224
225@item
226Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
227
228@item
229Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
230effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
231@end itemize
232
cce74817 233You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 234For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
235For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
236
cce74817
JM
237@cindex Chill
238@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 239Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 240see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 241
cce74817
JM
242@cindex Pascal
243Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
244nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
245entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
246syntax.
c906108c 247
c906108c
SS
248@cindex Fortran
249@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 250it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 251underscore.
c906108c 252
c906108c
SS
253@menu
254* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
256@end menu
257
6d2ebf8b 258@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
259@unnumberedsec Free software
260
5d161b24 261@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
262General Public License
263(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
264program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
265freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
266the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
267Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
268Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
269
270Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
271you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
272from anyone else.
273
6d2ebf8b 274@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
275@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
276
277Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
278other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
279development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
280of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
281to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
282file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
283blow-by-blow account.
284
285Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
286
287@quotation
288@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
289or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
290omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
291@end quotation
292
293So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
294particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
295releases:
8c70017b 296Andrew Cagney (release 5.0);
c906108c
SS
297Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
298Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
299Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
300Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
301Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
302John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
303Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
304and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
305
306Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
307Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
308
96a2c332
SS
309Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in
310@value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
311Bothner. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on
312C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading
313to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
314
315@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
316object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
317Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
318
319David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
320the original support for encapsulated COFF.
321
96c405b3 322Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
323
324Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
325Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
326support.
327Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
328Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
329Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
330David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
331Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
332Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
333Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
334Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
335Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
336Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
337Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
338Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
339Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
340Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
341Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
342
343Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
344
345Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
346libraries.
347
348Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
349about several machine instruction sets.
350
351Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
352remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
353contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
354and RDI targets, respectively.
355
356Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
357command-line editing and command history.
358
7a292a7a
SS
359Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
360Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 361
5d161b24 362Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
363He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
364symbols.
c906108c
SS
365
366Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
367Super-H processors.
368
369NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
370
371Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
372
373Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
374
375Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
376
96a2c332 377Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
378
379Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
380watchpoints.
381
382Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
383
384Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
385
386Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 387nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
388
389The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
390support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
391(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
392compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
393John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
394Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
395information in this manual.
396
96a2c332
SS
397Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
398development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
399fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
400Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
401Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
402Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
403Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
404addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
405JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
406Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
407Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
408Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
409Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
410Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
411Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
412
413
6d2ebf8b 414@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
415@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
416
417You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
418However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
419debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
420
421@iftex
422In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
423to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
424@end iftex
425
426@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
427@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
428
429One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
430processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
431quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
432definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
433session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
434then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
435same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
436@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
437procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
438
439@smallexample
440$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
441$ @b{./m4}
442@b{define(foo,0000)}
443
444@b{foo}
4450000
446@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
447
448@b{bar}
4490000
450@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
451
452@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
453@b{baz}
454@b{C-d}
455m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
456@end smallexample
457
458@noindent
459Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
460
c906108c
SS
461@smallexample
462$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
463@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
464@c FIXME... format to come out better.
465@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 466 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 467 the conditions.
5d161b24 468There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
469 for details.
470
471@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
472(@value{GDBP})
473@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
474
475@noindent
476@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
477rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
478We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
479that examples fit in this manual.
480
481@smallexample
482(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
483@end smallexample
484
485@noindent
486We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
487Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
488@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
489@code{break} command.
490
491@smallexample
492(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
493Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
494@end smallexample
495
496@noindent
497Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
498control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
499subroutine, the program runs as usual:
500
501@smallexample
502(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
503Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
504@b{define(foo,0000)}
505
506@b{foo}
5070000
508@end smallexample
509
510@noindent
511To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
512suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
513context where it stops.
514
515@smallexample
516@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
517
5d161b24 518Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
519 at builtin.c:879
520879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
521@end smallexample
522
523@noindent
524Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
525the next line of the current function.
526
527@smallexample
528(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
529882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
530 : nil,
531@end smallexample
532
533@noindent
534@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
535by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
536@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
537subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
538
539@smallexample
540(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
541set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
542 at input.c:530
543530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
544@end smallexample
545
546@noindent
547The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
548suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
549shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
550command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
551in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
552stack frame for each active subroutine.
553
554@smallexample
555(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
556#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
557 at input.c:530
5d161b24 558#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
559 at builtin.c:882
560#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
561#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
562 at macro.c:71
563#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
564#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
565@end smallexample
566
567@noindent
568We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
569times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
570falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
571
572@smallexample
573(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5740x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
575(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5760x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
577def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
578(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
579536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
580 : xstrdup(rq);
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
582538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
583@end smallexample
584
585@noindent
586The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
587@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
588and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
589(@code{print}) to see their values.
590
591@smallexample
592(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
593$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
594(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
595$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
596@end smallexample
597
598@noindent
599@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
600To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
601surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
602
603@smallexample
604(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
605533 xfree(rquote);
606534
607535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
608 : xstrdup (lq);
609536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
610 : xstrdup (rq);
611537
612538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
613539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
614540 @}
615541
616542 void
617@end smallexample
618
619@noindent
620Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
621@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
622
623@smallexample
624(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
625539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
626(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
627540 @}
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
629$3 = 9
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
631$4 = 7
632@end smallexample
633
634@noindent
635That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
636@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
637@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
638the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
639any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
640assignments.
641
642@smallexample
643(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
644$5 = 7
645(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
646$6 = 9
647@end smallexample
648
649@noindent
650Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
651@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
652executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
653example that caused trouble initially:
654
655@smallexample
656(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
657Continuing.
658
659@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
660
661baz
6620000
663@end smallexample
664
665@noindent
666Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
667problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
668lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
669
670@smallexample
671@b{C-d}
672Program exited normally.
673@end smallexample
674
675@noindent
676The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
677indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
678session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
679
680@smallexample
681(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
682@end smallexample
c906108c 683
6d2ebf8b 684@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
685@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
686
687This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 688The essentials are:
c906108c 689@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 690@item
53a5351d 691type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 692@item
c906108c
SS
693type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
694@end itemize
695
696@menu
697* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
698* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
699* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
700@end menu
701
6d2ebf8b 702@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
703@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
704
c906108c
SS
705Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
706@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
707
708You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
709to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
710
c906108c
SS
711The command-line options described here are designed
712to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 713options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
714
715The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
716specifying an executable program:
717
718@example
719@value{GDBP} @var{program}
720@end example
721
c906108c
SS
722@noindent
723You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
724specified:
725
726@example
727@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
728@end example
729
730You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
731to debug a running process:
732
733@example
734@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
735@end example
736
737@noindent
738would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
739named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
740
c906108c 741Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
742complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
743debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
744``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
745will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 746
96a2c332 747You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
748@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
749
750@smallexample
751@value{GDBP} -silent
752@end smallexample
753
754@noindent
755You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
756options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
757
758@noindent
759Type
760
761@example
762@value{GDBP} -help
763@end example
764
765@noindent
766to display all available options and briefly describe their use
767(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
768
769All options and command line arguments you give are processed
770in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
771@samp{-x} option is used.
772
773
774@menu
c906108c
SS
775* File Options:: Choosing files
776* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
777@end menu
778
6d2ebf8b 779@node File Options
c906108c
SS
780@subsection Choosing files
781
2df3850c 782When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
783specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
784the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
785@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
786that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
787@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
788that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
789the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
790
791If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
792such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
793argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
794
795Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
796following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
797them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
798(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
799than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
800
d700128c
EZ
801@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
802@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
803@c it.
804
c906108c
SS
805@table @code
806@item -symbols @var{file}
807@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
808@cindex @code{--symbols}
809@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
810Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
811
812@item -exec @var{file}
813@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
814@cindex @code{--exec}
815@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
816Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
817and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
818
819@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 820@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
821Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
822file.
823
c906108c
SS
824@item -core @var{file}
825@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
826@cindex @code{--core}
827@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
828Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
829
830@item -c @var{number}
831Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
832(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
833case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
834
835@item -command @var{file}
836@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
837@cindex @code{--command}
838@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
839Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
840Files,, Command files}.
841
842@item -directory @var{directory}
843@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
844@cindex @code{--directory}
845@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
846Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
847
c906108c
SS
848@item -m
849@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
850@cindex @code{--mapped}
851@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
852@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
853supported on all systems.}@*
854If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 855system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
856to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
857program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 858called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
859Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
860and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
861the symbol table from the executable program.
862
863The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
864is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
865table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 866
c906108c
SS
867@item -r
868@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
869@cindex @code{--readnow}
870@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
871Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
872the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
873This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 874
c906108c
SS
875@end table
876
2df3850c 877You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 878order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
879information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
880on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
881but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
882
883@example
2df3850c 884gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 885@end example
c906108c 886
6d2ebf8b 887@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
888@subsection Choosing modes
889
890You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
891batch mode or quiet mode.
892
893@table @code
894@item -nx
895@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
896@cindex @code{--nx}
897@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
898Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
899called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
900@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
901options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
902files}.
c906108c
SS
903
904@item -quiet
d700128c 905@itemx -silent
c906108c 906@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
907@cindex @code{--quiet}
908@cindex @code{--silent}
909@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
910``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
911messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
912
913@item -batch
d700128c 914@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
915Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
916command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
917initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
918nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
919in the command files.
920
2df3850c
JM
921Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
922example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
923make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
924
925@example
926Program exited normally.
927@end example
928
929@noindent
2df3850c
JM
930(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
931@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
932mode.
933
934@item -nowindows
935@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
936@cindex @code{--nowindows}
937@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 938``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 939(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
940interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
941
942@item -windows
943@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
944@cindex @code{--windows}
945@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
946If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
947used if possible.
c906108c
SS
948
949@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 950@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
951Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
952instead of the current directory.
953
c906108c
SS
954@item -fullname
955@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
956@cindex @code{--fullname}
957@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
958@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
959subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
960number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
961displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
962recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
963the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
964and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
965@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
966frame.
c906108c 967
d700128c
EZ
968@item -epoch
969@cindex @code{--epoch}
970The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
971@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
972routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
973separate window.
974
975@item -annotate @var{level}
976@cindex @code{--annotate}
977This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
978effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
979(@pxref{Annotations}).
980Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
981together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
982types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
983@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
984maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
985
986@item -async
987@cindex @code{--async}
988Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
989@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
990special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
991commands in parallel with the debugged process being
992run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
993MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
994suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
995control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
996(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
997operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
998yet.)
999@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1000@c should be removed.
1001
1002When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1003uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1004@samp{-noasync} option.
1005
1006@item -noasync
1007@cindex @code{--noasync}
1008Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1009
2df3850c
JM
1010@item -baud @var{bps}
1011@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1012@cindex @code{--baud}
1013@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1014Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1015interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1016
1017@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1018@itemx -t @var{device}
1019@cindex @code{--tty}
1020@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1021Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1022@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1023
53a5351d
JM
1024@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1025@c @item -tui
d700128c 1026@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1027@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1028@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1029@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1030@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1031@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1032
1033@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1034@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1035@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1036@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1037@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1038@c systems.
1039
d700128c
EZ
1040@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1041@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1042Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1043program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1044communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1045@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
7162c0ca 1046interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
d700128c
EZ
1047
1048@item -write
1049@cindex @code{--write}
1050Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1051is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1052(@pxref{Patching}).
1053
1054@item -statistics
1055@cindex @code{--statistics}
1056This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1057memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1058
1059@item -version
1060@cindex @code{--version}
1061This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1062no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1063
c906108c
SS
1064@end table
1065
6d2ebf8b 1066@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1067@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1068@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1069@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1070
1071@table @code
1072@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1073@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1074@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1075@itemx q
1076To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1077@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1078do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1079otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1080error code.
c906108c
SS
1081@end table
1082
1083@cindex interrupt
1084An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1085terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1086returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1087character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1088until a time when it is safe.
1089
c906108c
SS
1090If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1091device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1092(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1093
6d2ebf8b 1094@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1095@section Shell commands
1096
1097If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1098debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1099just use the @code{shell} command.
1100
1101@table @code
1102@kindex shell
1103@cindex shell escape
1104@item shell @var{command string}
1105Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1106If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1107shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1108(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1109@end table
1110
1111The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1112You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1113@value{GDBN}:
1114
1115@table @code
1116@kindex make
1117@cindex calling make
1118@item make @var{make-args}
1119Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1120arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1121@end table
1122
6d2ebf8b 1123@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1124@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1125
1126You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1127name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1128@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1129key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1130show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1131
1132@menu
1133* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1134* Completion:: Command completion
1135* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1136@end menu
1137
6d2ebf8b 1138@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1139@section Command syntax
1140
1141A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1142how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1143arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1144command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1145step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1146with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1147
1148@cindex abbreviation
1149@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1150unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1151documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1152abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1153equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1154names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1155arguments to the @code{help} command.
1156
1157@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1158@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1159A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1160repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1161will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1162repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1163repeat.
1164
1165The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1166@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1167exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1168
1169@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1170output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1171(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1172@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1173repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1174
41afff9a 1175@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1176@cindex comment
1177Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1178nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1179Files,,Command files}).
1180
6d2ebf8b 1181@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1182@section Command completion
1183
1184@cindex completion
1185@cindex word completion
1186@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1187only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1188are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1189commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1190
1191Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1192of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1193word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1194enter it). For example, if you type
1195
1196@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1197@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1198@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1199@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1200@example
1201(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1202@end example
1203
1204@noindent
1205@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1206the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1207
1208@example
1209(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1210@end example
1211
1212@noindent
1213You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1214breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1215@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1216were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1217might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1218to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1219
1220If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1221@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1222characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1223@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1224example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1225begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1226just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1227function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1228example:
1229
1230@example
1231(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1232@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1233make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1234make_abs_section make_function_type
1235make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1236make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1237make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1238(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1239@end example
1240
1241@noindent
1242After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1243partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1244command.
1245
1246If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1247can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1248means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1249key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1250one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1251
1252@cindex quotes in commands
1253@cindex completion of quoted strings
1254Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1255parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1256its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1257situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1258@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1259
c906108c
SS
1260The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1261name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1262(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1263type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1264distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1265@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1266@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1267facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1268beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1269consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1270@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1271
1272@example
96a2c332 1273(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1274bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1275(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1276@end example
1277
1278In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1279quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1280completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1281place:
1282
1283@example
1284(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1285@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1286(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1287@end example
1288
1289@noindent
1290In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1291you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1292completion on an overloaded symbol.
1293
d4f3574e 1294For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1295expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1296overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1297see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1298
1299
6d2ebf8b 1300@node Help
c906108c
SS
1301@section Getting help
1302@cindex online documentation
1303@kindex help
1304
5d161b24 1305You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1306using the command @code{help}.
1307
1308@table @code
41afff9a 1309@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1310@item help
1311@itemx h
1312You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1313display a short list of named classes of commands:
1314
1315@smallexample
1316(@value{GDBP}) help
1317List of classes of commands:
1318
2df3850c 1319aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1320breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1321data -- Examining data
c906108c 1322files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1323internals -- Maintenance commands
1324obscure -- Obscure features
1325running -- Running the program
1326stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1327status -- Status inquiries
1328support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1329tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1330 stopping the program
c906108c 1331user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1332
5d161b24 1333Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1334commands in that class.
5d161b24 1335Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1336documentation.
1337Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1338(@value{GDBP})
1339@end smallexample
96a2c332 1340@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1341
1342@item help @var{class}
1343Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1344list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1345help display for the class @code{status}:
1346
1347@smallexample
1348(@value{GDBP}) help status
1349Status inquiries.
1350
1351List of commands:
1352
1353@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1354@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1355info -- Generic command for showing things
1356 about the program being debugged
1357show -- Generic command for showing things
1358 about the debugger
c906108c 1359
5d161b24 1360Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1361documentation.
1362Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1363(@value{GDBP})
1364@end smallexample
1365
1366@item help @var{command}
1367With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1368short paragraph on how to use that command.
1369
6837a0a2
DB
1370@kindex apropos
1371@item apropos @var{args}
1372The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1373commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1374@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1375
1376@smallexample
1377apropos reload
1378@end smallexample
1379
1380@noindent results in:
1381
1382@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1383@c @group
1384set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1385 multiple times in one run
1386show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1387 multiple times in one run
1388@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1389@end smallexample
1390
c906108c
SS
1391@kindex complete
1392@item complete @var{args}
1393The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1394for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1395command you want completed. For example:
1396
1397@smallexample
1398complete i
1399@end smallexample
1400
1401@noindent results in:
1402
1403@smallexample
1404@group
2df3850c
JM
1405if
1406ignore
c906108c
SS
1407info
1408inspect
c906108c
SS
1409@end group
1410@end smallexample
1411
1412@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1413@end table
1414
1415In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1416and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1417of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1418manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1419under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1420all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1421
1422@c @group
1423@table @code
1424@kindex info
41afff9a 1425@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1426@item info
1427This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1428program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1429with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1430registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1431You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1432@w{@code{help info}}.
1433
1434@kindex set
1435@item set
5d161b24 1436You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1437@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1438@code{set prompt $}.
1439
1440@kindex show
1441@item show
5d161b24 1442In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1443@value{GDBN} itself.
1444You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1445related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1446system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1447which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1448
1449@kindex info set
1450To display all the settable parameters and their current
1451values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1452@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1453@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1454@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1455@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1456@end table
1457@c @end group
1458
1459Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1460exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1461
1462@table @code
1463@kindex show version
1464@cindex version number
1465@item show version
1466Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1467information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1468@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1469version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1470commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1471system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1472variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1473The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1474@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1475
1476@kindex show copying
1477@item show copying
1478Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1479
1480@kindex show warranty
1481@item show warranty
2df3850c 1482Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1483if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1484
c906108c
SS
1485@end table
1486
6d2ebf8b 1487@node Running
c906108c
SS
1488@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1489
1490When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1491debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1492
1493You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1494of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1495your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1496kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1497
1498@menu
1499* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1500* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1501* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1502* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1503
1504* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1505* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1506* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1507* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1508
1509* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1510* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1511@end menu
1512
6d2ebf8b 1513@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1514@section Compiling for debugging
1515
1516In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1517debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1518is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1519variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1520and addresses in the executable code.
1521
1522To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1523the compiler.
1524
1525Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1526options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1527executables containing debugging information.
1528
53a5351d
JM
1529@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1530without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1531recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1532program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1533in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1534
1535@cindex optimized code, debugging
1536@cindex debugging optimized code
1537When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1538optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1539really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1540exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1541variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1542variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1543
1544Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1545@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1546doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1547please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1548
1549Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1550@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1551format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1552
1553@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1554@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1555@section Starting your program
1556@cindex starting
1557@cindex running
1558
1559@table @code
1560@kindex run
41afff9a 1561@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1562@item run
1563@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1564Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1565You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1566argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1567@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1568(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1569
1570@end table
1571
c906108c
SS
1572If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1573supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1574that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1575@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1576
1577The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1578receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1579information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1580can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1581your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1582divided into four categories:
1583
1584@table @asis
1585@item The @emph{arguments.}
1586Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1587@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1588is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1589(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1590the arguments.
1591In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1592@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1593@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1594
1595@item The @emph{environment.}
1596Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1597use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1598environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1599your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1600
1601@item The @emph{working directory.}
1602Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1603the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1604@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1605
1606@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1607Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1608standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1609in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1610set a different device for your program.
1611@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1612
1613@cindex pipes
1614@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1615pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1616program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1617wrong program.
1618@end table
c906108c
SS
1619
1620When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1621immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1622of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1623stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1624or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1625
1626If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1627time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1628table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1629your current breakpoints.
1630
6d2ebf8b 1631@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1632@section Your program's arguments
1633
1634@cindex arguments (to your program)
1635The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1636@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1637They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1638performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1639@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1640@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1641the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1642
1643On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1644@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1645calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1646the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1647
1648@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1649@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1650
c906108c 1651@table @code
41afff9a 1652@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1653@item set args
1654Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1655@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1656with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1657using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1658it again without arguments.
1659
1660@kindex show args
1661@item show args
1662Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1663@end table
1664
6d2ebf8b 1665@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1666@section Your program's environment
1667
1668@cindex environment (of your program)
1669The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1670their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1671your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1672path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1673the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1674debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1675environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1676
1677@table @code
1678@kindex path
1679@item path @var{directory}
1680Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1681(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1682The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1683You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1684system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1685MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1686is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1687
1688You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1689working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1690use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1691@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1692@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1693@var{directory} to the search path.
1694@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1695@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1696
1697@kindex show paths
1698@item show paths
1699Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1700environment variable).
1701
1702@kindex show environment
1703@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1704Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1705your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1706print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1707your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1708
1709@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1710@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1711Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1712changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1713be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1714any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1715parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1716null value.
1717@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1718@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1719
1720For example, this command:
1721
1722@example
1723set env USER = foo
1724@end example
1725
1726@noindent
d4f3574e 1727tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1728@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1729are not actually required.)
1730
1731@kindex unset environment
1732@item unset environment @var{varname}
1733Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1734program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1735@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1736rather than assigning it an empty value.
1737@end table
1738
d4f3574e
SS
1739@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1740the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1741by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1742@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1743that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1744@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1745your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1746files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1747@file{.profile}.
1748
6d2ebf8b 1749@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1750@section Your program's working directory
1751
1752@cindex working directory (of your program)
1753Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1754working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1755The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1756from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1757working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1758
1759The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1760that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1761specify files}.
1762
1763@table @code
1764@kindex cd
1765@item cd @var{directory}
1766Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1767
1768@kindex pwd
1769@item pwd
1770Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1771@end table
1772
6d2ebf8b 1773@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1774@section Your program's input and output
1775
1776@cindex redirection
1777@cindex i/o
1778@cindex terminal
1779By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1780the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1781to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1782modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1783running your program.
1784
1785@table @code
1786@kindex info terminal
1787@item info terminal
1788Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1789program is using.
1790@end table
1791
1792You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1793redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1794
1795@example
1796run > outfile
1797@end example
1798
1799@noindent
1800starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1801
1802@kindex tty
1803@cindex controlling terminal
1804Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1805with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1806argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1807commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1808process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1809
1810@example
1811tty /dev/ttyb
1812@end example
1813
1814@noindent
1815directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1816default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1817that as their controlling terminal.
1818
1819An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1820effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1821terminal.
1822
1823When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1824command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1825for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1826
6d2ebf8b 1827@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1828@section Debugging an already-running process
1829@kindex attach
1830@cindex attach
1831
1832@table @code
1833@item attach @var{process-id}
1834This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1835outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1836targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1837find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1838or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1839
1840@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1841executing the command.
1842@end table
1843
1844To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1845which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1846programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1847also have permission to send the process a signal.
1848
1849When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1850the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1851the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1852(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1853the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1854Specify Files}.
1855
1856The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1857process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1858with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1859you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1860can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1861process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1862attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1863
1864@table @code
1865@kindex detach
1866@item detach
1867When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1868@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1869the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1870that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1871are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1872@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1873executing the command.
1874@end table
1875
1876If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1877attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1878for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1879control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1880confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1881messages}).
1882
6d2ebf8b 1883@node Kill Process
c906108c 1884@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1885
1886@table @code
1887@kindex kill
1888@item kill
1889Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1890@end table
1891
1892This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1893running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1894is running.
1895
1896On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1897while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1898@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1899outside the debugger.
1900
1901The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1902relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1903executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1904next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1905reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1906breakpoint settings).
1907
6d2ebf8b 1908@node Threads
c906108c 1909@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1910
1911@cindex threads of execution
1912@cindex multiple threads
1913@cindex switching threads
1914In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1915may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1916of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1917the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1918that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1919modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1920registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1921
1922@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1923programs:
1924
1925@itemize @bullet
1926@item automatic notification of new threads
1927@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1928@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1929@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1930a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1931@item thread-specific breakpoints
1932@end itemize
1933
c906108c
SS
1934@quotation
1935@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1936@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1937If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1938effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1939from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1940like this:
1941
1942@smallexample
1943(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1944(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1945Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1946see the IDs of currently known threads.
1947@end smallexample
1948@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1949@c doesn't support threads"?
1950@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1951
1952@cindex focus of debugging
1953@cindex current thread
1954The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1955threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1956control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1957This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1958program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1959
41afff9a 1960@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1961@cindex thread identifier (system)
1962@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1963@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1964@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1965Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1966the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1967form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1968whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1969LynxOS, you might see
1970
1971@example
1972[New process 35 thread 27]
1973@end example
1974
1975@noindent
1976when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1977the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1978further qualifier.
1979
1980@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1981@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1982@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1983@c program?
1984@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1985@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1986@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1987
1988@cindex thread number
1989@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1990For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1991number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1992
1993@table @code
1994@kindex info threads
1995@item info threads
1996Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1997program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1998
1999@enumerate
2000@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2001
2002@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2003
2004@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2005@end enumerate
2006
2007@noindent
2008An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2009indicates the current thread.
2010
5d161b24 2011For example,
c906108c
SS
2012@end table
2013@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2014
2015@smallexample
2016(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2017 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2018 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2019* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2020 at threadtest.c:68
2021@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2022
2023On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2024
2025@cindex thread number
2026@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2027For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2028number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2029thread in your program.
2030
41afff9a
EZ
2031@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2032@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2033@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2034@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2035@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2036Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2037both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2038form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2039whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2040HP-UX, you see
2041
2042@example
2043[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2044@end example
2045
2046@noindent
5d161b24 2047when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2048
2049@table @code
2050@kindex info threads
2051@item info threads
2052Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2053program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2054
2055@enumerate
2056@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2057
2058@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2059
2060@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2061@end enumerate
2062
2063@noindent
2064An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2065indicates the current thread.
2066
5d161b24 2067For example,
c906108c
SS
2068@end table
2069@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2070
2071@example
2072(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2073 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2074 at quicksort.c:137
2075 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2076 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2077 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2078 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2079@end example
c906108c
SS
2080
2081@table @code
2082@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2083@item thread @var{threadno}
2084Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2085argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2086shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2087@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2088you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2089
2090@smallexample
2091@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2092(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2093[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20940x34e5 in sigpause ()
2095@end smallexample
2096
2097@noindent
2098As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2099@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2100threads.
c906108c
SS
2101
2102@kindex thread apply
2103@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2104The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2105more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2106with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2107@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2108threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2109@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2110@end table
2111
2112@cindex automatic thread selection
2113@cindex switching threads automatically
2114@cindex threads, automatic switching
2115Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2116signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2117signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2118message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2119thread.
2120
2121@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2122more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2123programs with multiple threads.
2124
2125@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2126watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2127
6d2ebf8b 2128@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2129@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2130
2131@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2132@cindex multiple processes
2133@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2134On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2135programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2136function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2137parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2138set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2139will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2140will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2141
2142However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2143which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2144the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2145only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2146so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2147on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2148get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2149@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2150the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2151the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2152
53a5351d
JM
2153On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2154debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2155@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2156
2157By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2158the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2159
2160If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2161use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2162
2163@table @code
2164@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2165@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2166Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2167@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2168process. The @var{mode} can be:
2169
2170@table @code
2171@item parent
2172The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2173unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2174
2175@item child
2176The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2177unimpeded.
2178
2179@item ask
2180The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2181@end table
2182
2183@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2184Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2185@end table
2186
2187If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2188@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2189breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2190@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2191the child process's @code{main}.
2192
2193When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2194child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2195
2196If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2197call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2198use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2199argument.
2200
2201You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2202a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2203Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2204
6d2ebf8b 2205@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2206@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2207
2208The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2209program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2210trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2211
7a292a7a
SS
2212Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2213such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2214@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2215change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2216continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2217ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2218explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2219
2220@table @code
2221@kindex info program
2222@item info program
2223Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2224running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2225@end table
2226
2227@menu
2228* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2229* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2230* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2231* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2232@end menu
2233
6d2ebf8b 2234@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2235@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2236
2237@cindex breakpoints
2238A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2239the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2240control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2241breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2242Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2243should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2244program.
2245
2246In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2247breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2248a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2249is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2250not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2251arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2252
2253@cindex watchpoints
2254@cindex memory tracing
2255@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2256@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2257A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2258when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2259command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2260watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2261any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2262and watchpoints using the same commands.
2263
2264You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2265whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2266Automatic display}.
2267
2268@cindex catchpoints
2269@cindex breakpoint on events
2270A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2271when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2272exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2273different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2274catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2275other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2276@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2277
2278@cindex breakpoint numbers
2279@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2280@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2281catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2282starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2283features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2284breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2285@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2286enable it again.
2287
c5394b80
JM
2288@cindex breakpoint ranges
2289@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2290Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2291operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2292@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2293hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2294all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2295
c906108c
SS
2296@menu
2297* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2298* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2299* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2300* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2301* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2302* Conditions:: Break conditions
2303* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2304* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2305* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2306@end menu
2307
6d2ebf8b 2308@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2309@subsection Setting breakpoints
2310
5d161b24 2311@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2312@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2313@c
2314@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2315
2316@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2317@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2318@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2319@cindex latest breakpoint
2320Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2321@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2322number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2323Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2324convenience variables.
2325
2326You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2327
2328@table @code
2329@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2330Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2331When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2332C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2333@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2334
2335@item break +@var{offset}
2336@itemx break -@var{offset}
2337Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2338at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2339(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2340
2341@item break @var{linenum}
2342Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2343The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2344The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2345code on that line.
2346
2347@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2348Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2349
2350@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2351Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2352@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2353superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2354functions.
2355
2356@item break *@var{address}
2357Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2358breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2359information or source files.
2360
2361@item break
2362When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2363the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2364(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2365innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2366returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2367@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2368that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2369@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2370the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2371inside loops.
2372
2373@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2374least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2375would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2376breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2377existed when your program stopped.
2378
2379@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2380Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2381@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2382value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2383@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2384above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2385,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2386
2387@kindex tbreak
2388@item tbreak @var{args}
2389Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2390same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2391way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2392program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2393
c906108c
SS
2394@kindex hbreak
2395@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2396Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2397@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2398breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2399have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2400debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2401changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2402provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2403will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2404address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2405breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2406example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2407@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2408or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2409(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2410
2411@kindex thbreak
2412@item thbreak @var{args}
2413Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2414are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2415the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2416the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2417first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2418command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2419may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2420See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2421
2422@kindex rbreak
2423@cindex regular expression
2424@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2425Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2426@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2427matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2428breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2429the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2430them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2431
2432The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2433like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2434shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2435an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2436@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2437match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2438
c906108c
SS
2439When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2440breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2441classes.
c906108c
SS
2442
2443@kindex info breakpoints
2444@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2445@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2446@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2447@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2448Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2449not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2450
2451@table @emph
2452@item Breakpoint Numbers
2453@item Type
2454Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2455@item Disposition
2456Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2457@item Enabled or Disabled
2458Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2459that are not enabled.
2460@item Address
2df3850c 2461Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2462@item What
2463Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2464line number.
2465@end table
2466
2467@noindent
2468If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2469the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2470are listed after that.
2471
2472@noindent
2473@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2474number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2475convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2476the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2477listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2478
2479@noindent
2480@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2481has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2482@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2483hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2484was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2485will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2486@end table
2487
2488@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2489your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2490the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2491(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2492
2493@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2494@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2495@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2496purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2497These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2498@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2499
2500You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2501@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2502
2503@table @code
2504@kindex maint info breakpoints
2505@item maint info breakpoints
2506Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2507breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2508internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2509breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2510is shown:
2511
2512@table @code
2513@item breakpoint
2514Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2515
2516@item watchpoint
2517Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2518
2519@item longjmp
2520Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2521@code{longjmp} calls.
2522
2523@item longjmp resume
2524Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2525
2526@item until
2527Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2528
2529@item finish
2530Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2531
c906108c
SS
2532@item shlib events
2533Shared library events.
53a5351d 2534
c906108c 2535@end table
53a5351d 2536
c906108c
SS
2537@end table
2538
2539
6d2ebf8b 2540@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2541@subsection Setting watchpoints
2542
2543@cindex setting watchpoints
2544@cindex software watchpoints
2545@cindex hardware watchpoints
2546You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2547expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2548this may happen.
2549
2550Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2551hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2552program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2553times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2554catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2555culprit.)
2556
d4f3574e 2557On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2558@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2559hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2560program.
2561
2562@table @code
2563@kindex watch
2564@item watch @var{expr}
2565Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2566is written into by the program and its value changes.
2567
2568@kindex rwatch
2569@item rwatch @var{expr}
2570Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2571
2572@kindex awatch
2573@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2574Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2575by the program.
c906108c
SS
2576
2577@kindex info watchpoints
2578@item info watchpoints
2579This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2580it is the same as @code{info break}.
2581@end table
2582
2583@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2584watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2585value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2586cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2587executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2588statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2589
2590When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2591
2592@example
2593Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2594@end example
2595
2596@noindent
2597if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2598
7be570e7
JM
2599Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2600hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2601value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2602every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2603that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2604hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2605will print a message like this:
2606
2607@smallexample
2608Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2609@end smallexample
2610
2611Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2612data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2613watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2614can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2615cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2616double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2617wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2618into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2619
2620If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2621to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2622Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2623time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2624able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2625warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2626
2627@smallexample
2628Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2629@end smallexample
2630
2631@noindent
2632If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2633
2634The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2635or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2636data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2637hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2638both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2639watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2640@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2641watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2642@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2643Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2644
2645If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2646any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2647kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2648
7be570e7
JM
2649@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2650(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2651they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2652which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2653being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2654and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2655rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2656way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2657@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2658
c906108c
SS
2659@quotation
2660@cindex watchpoints and threads
2661@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2662@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2663usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2664can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2665you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2666thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2667can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2668@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2669the expression.
53a5351d 2670
d4f3574e 2671@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2672@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2673have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2674watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2675single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2676change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2677confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2678software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2679when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2680watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2681@end quotation
c906108c 2682
6d2ebf8b 2683@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2684@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2685@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2686@cindex exception handlers
2687@cindex event handling
2688
2689You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2690kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2691shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2692
2693@table @code
2694@kindex catch
2695@item catch @var{event}
2696Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2697@table @code
2698@item throw
2699@kindex catch throw
2700The throwing of a C++ exception.
2701
2702@item catch
2703@kindex catch catch
2704The catching of a C++ exception.
2705
2706@item exec
2707@kindex catch exec
2708A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2709
2710@item fork
2711@kindex catch fork
2712A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2713
2714@item vfork
2715@kindex catch vfork
2716A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2717
2718@item load
2719@itemx load @var{libname}
2720@kindex catch load
2721The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2722@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2723
2724@item unload
2725@itemx unload @var{libname}
2726@kindex catch unload
2727The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2728of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2729@end table
2730
2731@item tcatch @var{event}
2732Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2733automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2734
2735@end table
2736
2737Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2738
2739There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2740(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2741
2742@itemize @bullet
2743@item
2744If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2745control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2746raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2747returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2748simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2749that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2750you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2751disabled within interactive calls.
2752
2753@item
2754You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2755
2756@item
2757You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2758@end itemize
2759
2760@cindex raise exceptions
2761Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2762if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2763stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2764can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2765breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2766out where the exception was raised.
2767
2768To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2769knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2770raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2771which has the following ANSI C interface:
2772
2773@example
2774 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2775 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2776 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2777@end example
2778
2779@noindent
2780To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2781unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2782(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2783
2784With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2785that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2786a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2787breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2788raised.
2789
2790
6d2ebf8b 2791@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2792@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2793
2794@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2795@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2796It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2797catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2798to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2799breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2800
2801With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2802where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2803delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2804their breakpoint numbers.
2805
2806It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2807automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2808when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2809
2810@table @code
2811@kindex clear
2812@item clear
2813Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2814selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2815the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2816breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2817
2818@item clear @var{function}
2819@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2820Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2821
2822@item clear @var{linenum}
2823@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2824Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2825
2826@cindex delete breakpoints
2827@kindex delete
41afff9a 2828@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2829@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2830Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2831ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2832breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2833confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2834@end table
2835
6d2ebf8b 2836@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2837@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2838
2839@kindex disable breakpoints
2840@kindex enable breakpoints
2841Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2842prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2843it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2844that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2845
2846You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2847the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2848or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2849@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2850catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2851
2852A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2853states of enablement:
2854
2855@itemize @bullet
2856@item
2857Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2858with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2859@item
2860Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2861@item
2862Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2863disabled.
c906108c
SS
2864@item
2865Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2866immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2867set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2868@end itemize
2869
2870You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2871watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2872
2873@table @code
2874@kindex disable breakpoints
2875@kindex disable
41afff9a 2876@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2877@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2878Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2879listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2880options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2881case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2882@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2883
2884@kindex enable breakpoints
2885@kindex enable
c5394b80 2886@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2887Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2888become effective once again in stopping your program.
2889
c5394b80 2890@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2891Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2892of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2893
c5394b80 2894@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2895Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2896deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2897@end table
2898
d4f3574e
SS
2899@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2900@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2901Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2902,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2903subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2904the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2905breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2906breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2907stepping}.)
2908
6d2ebf8b 2909@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2910@subsection Break conditions
2911@cindex conditional breakpoints
2912@cindex breakpoint conditions
2913
2914@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2915@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2916The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2917specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2918breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2919programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2920a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2921and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2922
2923This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2924situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2925when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2926by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2927@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2928
2929Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2930since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2931it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2932and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2933one.
2934
2935Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2936your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2937that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2938format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2939unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2940that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2941program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2942breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2943conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2944purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2945(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2946
2947Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2948@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2949Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2950with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2951
c906108c
SS
2952You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2953The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2954@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2955catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2956
2957@table @code
2958@kindex condition
2959@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2960Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2961watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2962breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2963@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2964@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2965syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2966referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2967symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2968prints an error message:
2969
2970@example
2971No symbol "foo" in current context.
2972@end example
2973
2974@noindent
c906108c
SS
2975@value{GDBN} does
2976not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2977command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2978@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2979
2980@item condition @var{bnum}
2981Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2982an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2983@end table
2984
2985@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2986A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2987breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2988useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2989count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2990is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2991therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2992ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2993the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2994value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2995your program reaches it.
2996
2997@table @code
2998@kindex ignore
2999@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3000Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3001The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3002execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3003takes no action.
3004
3005To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3006a count of zero.
3007
3008When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3009breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3010@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3011Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3012
3013If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3014condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3015@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3016
3017You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3018as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3019is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3020variables}.
3021@end table
3022
3023Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3024
3025
6d2ebf8b 3026@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3027@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3028
3029@cindex breakpoint commands
3030You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3031commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3032example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3033enable other breakpoints.
3034
3035@table @code
3036@kindex commands
3037@kindex end
3038@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3039@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3040@itemx end
3041Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3042themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3043@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3044
3045To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3046follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3047
3048With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3049breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3050recently encountered).
3051@end table
3052
3053Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3054disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3055
3056You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3057use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3058that resumes execution.
3059
3060Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3061execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3062(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3063another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3064ambiguities about which list to execute.
3065
3066@kindex silent
3067If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3068usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3069be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3070then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3071see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3072meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3073
3074The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3075print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3076breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3077
3078For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3079value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3080
3081@example
3082break foo if x>0
3083commands
3084silent
3085printf "x is %d\n",x
3086cont
3087end
3088@end example
3089
3090One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3091you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3092of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3093erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3094to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3095so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3096command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3097
3098@example
3099break 403
3100commands
3101silent
3102set x = y + 4
3103cont
3104end
3105@end example
3106
6d2ebf8b 3107@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3108@subsection Breakpoint menus
3109@cindex overloading
3110@cindex symbol overloading
3111
3112Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3113to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3114This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3115@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3116a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3117something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3118particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3119you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3120waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3121options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3122sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3123@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3124breakpoints.
3125
3126For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3127breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3128We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3129
3130@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3131@smallexample
3132@group
3133(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3134[0] cancel
3135[1] all
3136[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3137[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3138[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3139[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3140[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3141[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3142> 2 4 6
3143Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3144Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3145Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3146Multiple breakpoints were set.
3147Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3148 breakpoints.
3149(@value{GDBP})
3150@end group
3151@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3152
3153@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3154@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3155@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3156@c
3157@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3158@c
d4f3574e
SS
3159Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3160any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3161attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3162@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3163
3164@example
3165Cannot insert breakpoints.
3166The same program may be running in another process.
3167@end example
3168
3169When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3170
3171@enumerate
3172@item
3173Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3174
3175@item
5d161b24 3176Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3177name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3178that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3179Then start your program again.
3180
3181@item
3182Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3183linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3184to nonsharable executables.
3185@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3186@c @end ifclear
3187
d4f3574e
SS
3188A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3189hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3190
3191@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3192@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3193@smallexample
3194Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3195You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3196@end smallexample
3197
3198@noindent
3199This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3200only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3201watchpoints it needs to insert.
3202
3203When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3204hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3205
3206
6d2ebf8b 3207@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3208@section Continuing and stepping
3209
3210@cindex stepping
3211@cindex continuing
3212@cindex resuming execution
3213@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3214completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3215one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3216line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3217particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3218your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3219it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3220@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3221
3222@table @code
3223@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3224@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3225@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3226@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3227@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3228@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3229Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3230any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3231@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3232ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3233@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3234
3235The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3236stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3237@code{continue} is ignored.
3238
d4f3574e
SS
3239The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3240debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3241purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3242@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3243@end table
3244
3245To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3246(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3247calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3248different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3249
3250A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3251(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3252beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3253is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3254and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3255interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3256
3257@table @code
3258@kindex step
41afff9a 3259@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3260@item step
3261Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3262line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3263abbreviated @code{s}.
3264
3265@quotation
3266@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3267@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3268@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3269@c distinction here.
3270@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3271within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3272execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3273debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3274is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3275without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3276below.
3277@end quotation
3278
4a92d011
EZ
3279The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3280line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3281@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3282to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3283the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3284called within the line.
c906108c 3285
d4f3574e
SS
3286Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3287number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3288@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3289on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3290was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3291
3292@item step @var{count}
3293Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3294breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3295@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3296
3297@kindex next
41afff9a 3298@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3299@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3300Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3301This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3302the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3303control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3304that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3305is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3306
3307An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3308
3309
3310@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3311@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3312@c
3313@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3314@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3315@c function are executed without stopping.
3316
d4f3574e
SS
3317The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3318source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3319@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3320
b90a5f51
CF
3321@kindex set step-mode
3322@item set step-mode
3323@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3324@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3325@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3326The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3327stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3328information rather than stepping over it.
3329
4a92d011
EZ
3330This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3331machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3332want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3333
3334@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3335Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3336debug information. This is the default.
3337
c906108c
SS
3338@kindex finish
3339@item finish
3340Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3341returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3342
3343Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3344,Returning from a function}).
3345
3346@kindex until
41afff9a 3347@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3348@item until
3349@itemx u
3350Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3351current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3352stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3353command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3354automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3355than the address of the jump.
3356
3357This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3358though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3359exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3360simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3361through the next iteration.
3362
3363@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3364stack frame.
3365
3366@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3367of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3368example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3369(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3370@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3371
3372@example
3373(@value{GDBP}) f
3374#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3375206 expand_input();
3376(@value{GDBP}) until
3377195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3378@end example
3379
3380This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3381generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3382start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3383written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3384to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3385expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3386statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3387
3388@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3389instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3390argument.
3391
3392@item until @var{location}
3393@itemx u @var{location}
3394Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3395reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3396the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3397,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3398and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3399
3400@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3401@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3402@item stepi
96a2c332 3403@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3404@itemx si
3405Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3406
3407It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3408instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3409instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3410Display,, Automatic display}.
3411
3412An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3413
3414@need 750
3415@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3416@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3417@item nexti
96a2c332 3418@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3419@itemx ni
3420Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3421proceed until the function returns.
3422
3423An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3424@end table
3425
6d2ebf8b 3426@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3427@section Signals
3428@cindex signals
3429
3430A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3431operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3432kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3433signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3434@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3435memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3436the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3437requested an alarm).
3438
3439@cindex fatal signals
3440Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3441functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3442errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3443program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3444@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3445fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3446
3447@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3448program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3449signal.
3450
3451@cindex handling signals
3452Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3453(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3454but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3455You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3456
3457@table @code
3458@kindex info signals
3459@item info signals
96a2c332 3460@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3461Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3462handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3463the defined types of signals.
3464
d4f3574e 3465@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3466
3467@kindex handle
3468@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3469Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3470can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3471@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numberss of the form
3472@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3473known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3474@end table
3475
3476@c @group
3477The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3478Their full names are:
3479
3480@table @code
3481@item nostop
3482@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3483still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3484
3485@item stop
3486@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3487the @code{print} keyword as well.
3488
3489@item print
3490@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3491
3492@item noprint
3493@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3494implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3495
3496@item pass
5ece1a18 3497@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3498@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3499can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3500and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3501
3502@item nopass
5ece1a18 3503@itemx ignore
c906108c 3504@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3505@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3506@end table
3507@c @end group
3508
d4f3574e
SS
3509When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3510program until you
c906108c
SS
3511continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3512effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3513after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3514command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3515program sees that signal when you continue.
3516
3517You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3518seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3519or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3520due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3521values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3522execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3523a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3524you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3525program a signal}.
c906108c 3526
6d2ebf8b 3527@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3528@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3529
3530When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3531programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3532breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3533
3534@table @code
3535@cindex breakpoints and threads
3536@cindex thread breakpoints
3537@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3538@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3539@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3540@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3541writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3542
3543Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3544to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3545particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3546numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3547column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3548
3549If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3550breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3551program.
3552
3553You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3554well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3555breakpoint condition, like this:
3556
3557@smallexample
2df3850c 3558(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3559@end smallexample
3560
3561@end table
3562
3563@cindex stopped threads
3564@cindex threads, stopped
3565Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3566@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3567allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3568switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3569underfoot.
3570
3571@cindex continuing threads
3572@cindex threads, continuing
3573Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3574executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3575like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3576
3577In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3578Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3579system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3580execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3581single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3582statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3583stops.
3584
3585You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3586continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3587thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3588first thread completes whatever you requested.
3589
3590On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3591thread to run.
3592
3593@table @code
3594@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3595Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3596locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3597current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3598mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3599``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3600stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3601when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3602function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3603like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3604thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3605@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3606
3607@item show scheduler-locking
3608Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3609@end table
3610
c906108c 3611
6d2ebf8b 3612@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3613@chapter Examining the Stack
3614
3615When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3616stopped and how it got there.
3617
3618@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3619Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3620is generated.
3621That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3622the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3623and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3624The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3625The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3626stack}.
3627
3628When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3629stack allow you to see all of this information.
3630
3631@cindex selected frame
3632One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3633@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3634particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3635your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3636special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3637interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3638
3639When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3640currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3641@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3642
3643@menu
3644* Frames:: Stack frames
3645* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3646* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3647* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3648
3649@end menu
3650
6d2ebf8b 3651@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3652@section Stack frames
3653
d4f3574e 3654@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3655@cindex stack frame
3656The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3657frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3658with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3659to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3660which the function is executing.
3661
3662@cindex initial frame
3663@cindex outermost frame
3664@cindex innermost frame
3665When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3666function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3667@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3668made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3669is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3670the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3671actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3672recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3673
3674@cindex frame pointer
3675Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3676stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3677kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3678address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3679in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3680going on in that frame.
3681
3682@cindex frame number
3683@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3684zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3685and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3686they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3687frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3688
6d2ebf8b
SS
3689@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3690@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3691@cindex frameless execution
3692Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3693without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3694@example
3695@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3696@end example
3697generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3698This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3699the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3700with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3701has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3702it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3703correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3704no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3705
3706@table @code
d4f3574e 3707@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3708@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3709@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3710The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3711and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3712address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3713@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3714
3715@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3716@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3717@item select-frame
3718The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3719to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3720@code{frame}.
3721@end table
3722
6d2ebf8b 3723@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3724@section Backtraces
3725
3726@cindex backtraces
3727@cindex tracebacks
3728@cindex stack traces
3729A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3730line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3731frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3732stack.
3733
3734@table @code
3735@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3736@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3737@item backtrace
3738@itemx bt
3739Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3740frames in the stack.
3741
3742You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3743character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3744
3745@item backtrace @var{n}
3746@itemx bt @var{n}
3747Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3748
3749@item backtrace -@var{n}
3750@itemx bt -@var{n}
3751Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3752@end table
3753
3754@kindex where
3755@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3756@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3757The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3758are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3759
3760Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3761The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3762print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3763line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3764counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3765line number.
3766
3767Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3768@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3769
3770@smallexample
3771@group
5d161b24 3772#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3773 at builtin.c:993
3774#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3775#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3776 at macro.c:71
3777(More stack frames follow...)
3778@end group
3779@end smallexample
3780
3781@noindent
3782The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3783value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3784code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3785
6d2ebf8b 3786@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3787@section Selecting a frame
3788
3789Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3790whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3791selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3792of the stack frame just selected.
3793
3794@table @code
d4f3574e 3795@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3796@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3797@item frame @var{n}
3798@itemx f @var{n}
3799Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3800(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3801innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3802@code{main}.
3803
3804@item frame @var{addr}
3805@itemx f @var{addr}
3806Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3807chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3808impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3809addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3810switches between them.
3811
c906108c
SS
3812On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3813select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3814
3815On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3816pointer and a program counter.
3817
3818On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3819pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3820@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3821@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3822@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3823
3824@kindex up
3825@item up @var{n}
3826Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3827advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3828that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3829
3830@kindex down
41afff9a 3831@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3832@item down @var{n}
3833Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3834advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3835that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3836abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3837@end table
3838
3839All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3840frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3841arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3842frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3843
3844@need 1000
3845For example:
3846
3847@smallexample
3848@group
3849(@value{GDBP}) up
3850#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3851 at env.c:10
385210 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3853@end group
3854@end smallexample
3855
3856After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3857prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3858@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3859
3860@table @code
3861@kindex down-silently
3862@kindex up-silently
3863@item up-silently @var{n}
3864@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3865These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3866respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3867causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3868in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3869distracting.
3870@end table
3871
6d2ebf8b 3872@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3873@section Information about a frame
3874
3875There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3876stack frame.
3877
3878@table @code
3879@item frame
3880@itemx f
3881When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3882frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3883selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3884argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3885@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3886
3887@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3888@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3889@item info frame
3890@itemx info f
3891This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3892including:
3893
3894@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3895@item
3896the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3897@item
3898the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3899@item
3900the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3901@item
3902the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3903@item
3904the address of the frame's arguments
3905@item
d4f3574e
SS
3906the address of the frame's local variables
3907@item
c906108c
SS
3908the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3909@item
3910which registers were saved in the frame
3911@end itemize
3912
3913@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3914something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3915the usual conventions.
3916
3917@item info frame @var{addr}
3918@itemx info f @var{addr}
3919Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3920selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3921command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3922architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3923@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3924
3925@kindex info args
3926@item info args
3927Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3928
3929@item info locals
3930@kindex info locals
3931Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3932line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3933accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3934
c906108c 3935@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3936@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3937@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3938@item info catch
3939Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3940current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3941exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3942@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3943@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3944
c906108c
SS
3945@end table
3946
c906108c 3947
6d2ebf8b 3948@node Source
c906108c
SS
3949@chapter Examining Source Files
3950
3951@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3952information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3953used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3954the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3955(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3956execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3957source files by explicit command.
3958
7a292a7a 3959If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3960prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3961@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3962
3963@menu
3964* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3965* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3966* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3967* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3968@end menu
3969
6d2ebf8b 3970@node List
c906108c
SS
3971@section Printing source lines
3972
3973@kindex list
41afff9a 3974@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3975To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3976(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3977There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3978
3979Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3980
3981@table @code
3982@item list @var{linenum}
3983Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3984current source file.
3985
3986@item list @var{function}
3987Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3988@var{function}.
3989
3990@item list
3991Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3992@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3993printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3994as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3995Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3996
3997@item list -
3998Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3999@end table
4000
4001By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4002the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4003
4004@table @code
4005@kindex set listsize
4006@item set listsize @var{count}
4007Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4008the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4009
4010@kindex show listsize
4011@item show listsize
4012Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4013@end table
4014
4015Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4016so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4017than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4018argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4019each repetition moves up in the source file.
4020
4021@cindex linespec
4022In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4023@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4024of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4025Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4026
4027@table @code
4028@item list @var{linespec}
4029Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4030
4031@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4032Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4033linespecs.
4034
4035@item list ,@var{last}
4036Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4037
4038@item list @var{first},
4039Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4040
4041@item list +
4042Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4043
4044@item list -
4045Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4046
4047@item list
4048As described in the preceding table.
4049@end table
4050
4051Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4052kinds of linespec.
4053
4054@table @code
4055@item @var{number}
4056Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4057When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4058the same source file as the first linespec.
4059
4060@item +@var{offset}
4061Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4062When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4063two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4064first linespec.
4065
4066@item -@var{offset}
4067Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4068
4069@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4070Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4071
4072@item @var{function}
4073Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4074For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4075
4076@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4077Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4078function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4079file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4080identically named functions in different source files.
4081
4082@item *@var{address}
4083Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4084@var{address} may be any expression.
4085@end table
4086
6d2ebf8b 4087@node Search
c906108c
SS
4088@section Searching source files
4089@cindex searching
4090@kindex reverse-search
4091
4092There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4093regular expression.
4094
4095@table @code
4096@kindex search
4097@kindex forward-search
4098@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4099@itemx search @var{regexp}
4100The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4101starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4102@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4103synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4104@code{fo}.
4105
4106@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4107The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4108with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4109for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4110this command as @code{rev}.
4111@end table
c906108c 4112
6d2ebf8b 4113@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4114@section Specifying source directories
4115
4116@cindex source path
4117@cindex directories for source files
4118Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4119files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4120the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4121session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4122this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4123it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4124in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4125the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4126the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4127path.
4128
4129If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4130object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4131too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4132compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4133last resort.
4134
4135Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4136any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4137each line is in the file.
4138
4139@kindex directory
4140@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4141When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4142and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4143To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4144
4145@table @code
4146@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4147@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4148Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4149directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4150(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4151part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4152whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4153path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4154
4155@kindex cdir
4156@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4157@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4158@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4159@cindex compilation directory
4160@cindex current directory
4161@cindex working directory
4162@cindex directory, current
4163@cindex directory, compilation
4164You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4165directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4166working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4167tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4168session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4169directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4170
4171@item directory
4172Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4173
4174@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4175@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4176
4177@item show directories
4178@kindex show directories
4179Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4180@end table
4181
4182If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4183interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4184versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4185
4186@enumerate
4187@item
4188Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4189
4190@item
4191Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4192directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4193directories in one command.
4194@end enumerate
4195
6d2ebf8b 4196@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4197@section Source and machine code
4198
4199You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4200addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4201a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4202mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4203line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4204well as hex.
4205
4206@table @code
4207@kindex info line
4208@item info line @var{linespec}
4209Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4210source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4211the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4212source lines}).
4213@end table
4214
4215For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4216the object code for the first line of function
4217@code{m4_changequote}:
4218
d4f3574e
SS
4219@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4220@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4221@smallexample
96a2c332 4222(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4223Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4224@end smallexample
4225
4226@noindent
4227We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4228@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4229@smallexample
4230(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4231Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4232@end smallexample
4233
4234@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4235@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4236After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4237is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4238sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4239,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4240convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4241variables}).
4242
4243@table @code
4244@kindex disassemble
4245@cindex assembly instructions
4246@cindex instructions, assembly
4247@cindex machine instructions
4248@cindex listing machine instructions
4249@item disassemble
4250This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4251instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4252program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4253command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4254surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4255(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4256@end table
4257
c906108c
SS
4258The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4259HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4260
4261@smallexample
4262(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4263Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42640x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42650x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42660x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42670x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42680x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42690x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42700x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42710x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4272End of assembler dump.
4273@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4274
4275Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4276mnemonics or other syntax.
4277
4278@table @code
d4f3574e 4279@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4280@cindex assembly instructions
4281@cindex instructions, assembly
4282@cindex machine instructions
4283@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4284@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4285@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4286@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4287Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4288program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4289
4290Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4291can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4292The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4293assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4294@end table
4295
4296
6d2ebf8b 4297@node Data
c906108c
SS
4298@chapter Examining Data
4299
4300@cindex printing data
4301@cindex examining data
4302@kindex print
4303@kindex inspect
4304@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4305@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4306@c different window or something like that.
4307The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4308command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4309evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4310program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4311Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4312
4313@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4314@item print @var{expr}
4315@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4316@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4317value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4318you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4319@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4320formats}.
4321
4322@item print
4323@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4324If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4325@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4326conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4327@end table
4328
4329A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4330It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4331specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4332
7a292a7a 4333If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4334fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4335command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4336Table}.
c906108c
SS
4337
4338@menu
4339* Expressions:: Expressions
4340* Variables:: Program variables
4341* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4342* Output Formats:: Output formats
4343* Memory:: Examining memory
4344* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4345* Print Settings:: Print settings
4346* Value History:: Value history
4347* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4348* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4349* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4350* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4351@end menu
4352
6d2ebf8b 4353@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4354@section Expressions
4355
4356@cindex expressions
4357@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4358compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4359by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4360@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4361and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4362by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4363
d4f3574e
SS
4364@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4365the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4366you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4367memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4368
c906108c
SS
4369Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4370this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4371Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4372languages.
4373
4374In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4375expressions regardless of your programming language.
4376
4377Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4378useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4379at that address in memory.
4380@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4381
4382@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4383to programming languages:
4384
4385@table @code
4386@item @@
4387@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4388@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4389
4390@item ::
4391@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4392function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4393
4394@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4395@cindex type casting memory
4396@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4397@cindex casts, to view memory
4398@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4399Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4400memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4401pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4402a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4403normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4404@end table
4405
6d2ebf8b 4406@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4407@section Program variables
4408
4409The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4410in your program.
4411
4412Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4413(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4414
4415@itemize @bullet
4416@item
4417global (or file-static)
4418@end itemize
4419
5d161b24 4420@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4421
4422@itemize @bullet
4423@item
4424visible according to the scope rules of the
4425programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4426@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4427
4428@noindent This means that in the function
4429
4430@example
4431foo (a)
4432 int a;
4433@{
4434 bar (a);
4435 @{
4436 int b = test ();
4437 bar (b);
4438 @}
4439@}
4440@end example
4441
4442@noindent
4443you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4444executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4445examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4446the block where @code{b} is declared.
4447
4448@cindex variable name conflict
4449There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4450scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4451in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4452function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4453happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4454you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4455using the colon-colon notation:
4456
d4f3574e 4457@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4458@iftex
4459@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4460@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4461@end iftex
4462@example
4463@var{file}::@var{variable}
4464@var{function}::@var{variable}
4465@end example
4466
4467@noindent
4468Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4469static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4470make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4471to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4472
4473@example
4474(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4475@end example
4476
c906108c
SS
4477@cindex C++ scope resolution
4478This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4479use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4480scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4481@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4482@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4483
4484@cindex wrong values
4485@cindex variable values, wrong
4486@quotation
4487@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4488wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4489scope, and just before exit.
4490@end quotation
4491You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4492This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4493set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4494stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4495values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4496also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4497after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4498variable definitions may be gone.
4499
4500This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4501To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4502when compiling.
4503
d4f3574e
SS
4504@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4505Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4506unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4507opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4508offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4509might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4510happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4511
4512@example
4513No symbol "foo" in current context.
4514@end example
4515
4516To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4517different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4518formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4519supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4520in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4521to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4522debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4523Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4524information.
4525
4526
6d2ebf8b 4527@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4528@section Artificial arrays
4529
4530@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4531@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4532It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4533same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4534dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4535program.
4536
4537You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4538@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4539operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4540and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4541of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4542the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4543argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4544following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4545example. If a program says
4546
4547@example
4548int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4549@end example
4550
4551@noindent
4552you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4553
4554@example
4555p *array@@len
4556@end example
4557
4558The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4559with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4560subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4561Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4562(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4563
4564Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4565This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4566The value need not be in memory:
4567@example
4568(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4569$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4570@end example
4571
4572As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4573@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4574the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4575@example
4576(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4577$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4578@end example
4579
4580Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4581moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4582actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4583of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4584to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4585variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4586interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4587instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4588structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4589in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4590
4591@example
4592set $i = 0
4593p dtab[$i++]->fv
4594@key{RET}
4595@key{RET}
4596@dots{}
4597@end example
4598
6d2ebf8b 4599@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4600@section Output formats
4601
4602@cindex formatted output
4603@cindex output formats
4604By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4605this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4606in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4607at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4608these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4609
4610The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4611already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4612@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4613letters supported are:
4614
4615@table @code
4616@item x
4617Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4618hexadecimal.
4619
4620@item d
4621Print as integer in signed decimal.
4622
4623@item u
4624Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4625
4626@item o
4627Print as integer in octal.
4628
4629@item t
4630Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4631@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4632used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4633see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4634
4635@item a
4636@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4637@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4638Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4639the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4640where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4641
4642@example
4643(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4644$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4645@end example
4646
3d67e040
EZ
4647@noindent
4648The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4649@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4650
c906108c
SS
4651@item c
4652Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4653
4654@item f
4655Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4656using typical floating point syntax.
4657@end table
4658
4659For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4660
4661@example
4662p/x $pc
4663@end example
4664
4665@noindent
4666Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4667names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4668
4669To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4670you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4671expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4672
6d2ebf8b 4673@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4674@section Examining memory
4675
4676You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4677any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4678
4679@cindex examining memory
4680@table @code
41afff9a 4681@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4682@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4683@itemx x @var{addr}
4684@itemx x
4685Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4686@end table
4687
4688@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4689much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4690expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4691If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4692Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4693
4694@table @r
4695@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4696The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4697how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4698@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4699@c 4.1.2.
4700
4701@item @var{f}, the display format
4702The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4703@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4704The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4705The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4706
4707@item @var{u}, the unit size
4708The unit size is any of
4709
4710@table @code
4711@item b
4712Bytes.
4713@item h
4714Halfwords (two bytes).
4715@item w
4716Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4717@item g
4718Giant words (eight bytes).
4719@end table
4720
4721Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4722default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4723@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4724
4725@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4726@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4727memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4728it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4729@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4730@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4731other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4732the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4733starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4734a value from memory).
4735@end table
4736
4737For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4738(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4739starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4740words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4741@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4742
4743Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4744letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4745unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4746specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4747(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4748
4749Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4750and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4751@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4752including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4753alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4754Code,,Source and machine code}.
4755
4756All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4757easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4758you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4759instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4760with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4761the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4762for successive uses of @code{x}.
4763
4764@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4765The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4766in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4767would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4768subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4769@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4770examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4771@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4772the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4773
4774If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4775are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4776address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4777
6d2ebf8b 4778@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4779@section Automatic display
4780@cindex automatic display
4781@cindex display of expressions
4782
4783If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4784(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4785display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4786Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4787to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4788The automatic display looks like this:
4789
4790@example
47912: foo = 38
47923: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4793@end example
4794
4795@noindent
4796This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4797displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4798specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4799whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4800format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4801or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4802supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4803
4804@table @code
4805@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4806@item display @var{expr}
4807Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4808each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4809
4810@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4811
d4f3574e 4812@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4813For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4814count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4815arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4816@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4817
4818@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4819For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4820number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4821be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4822doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4823@end table
4824
4825For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4826instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4827is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4828
4829@table @code
4830@kindex delete display
4831@kindex undisplay
4832@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4833@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4834Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4835
4836@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4837(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4838
4839@kindex disable display
4840@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4841Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4842item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4843enabled again later.
4844
4845@kindex enable display
4846@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4847Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4848again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4849
4850@item display
4851Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4852done when your program stops.
4853
4854@kindex info display
4855@item info display
4856Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4857automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4858values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4859It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4860because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4861@end table
4862
4863If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4864sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4865expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4866variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4867@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4868@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4869continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4870there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4871automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4872is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4873
6d2ebf8b 4874@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4875@section Print settings
4876
4877@cindex format options
4878@cindex print settings
4879@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4880and symbols are printed.
4881
4882@noindent
4883These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4884
4885@table @code
4886@kindex set print address
4887@item set print address
4888@itemx set print address on
4889@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4890traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4891even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4892is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4893@code{set print address on}:
4894
4895@smallexample
4896@group
4897(@value{GDBP}) f
4898#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4899 at input.c:530
4900530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4901@end group
4902@end smallexample
4903
4904@item set print address off
4905Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4906this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4907
4908@smallexample
4909@group
4910(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4911(@value{GDBP}) f
4912#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4913530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4914@end group
4915@end smallexample
4916
4917You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4918dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4919@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4920all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4921
4922@kindex show print address
4923@item show print address
4924Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4925@end table
4926
4927When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4928closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4929identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4930source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4931@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4932you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4933it prints a symbolic address:
4934
4935@table @code
4936@kindex set print symbol-filename
4937@item set print symbol-filename on
4938Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4939symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4940
4941@item set print symbol-filename off
4942Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4943default.
4944
4945@kindex show print symbol-filename
4946@item show print symbol-filename
4947Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4948line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4949@end table
4950
4951Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4952numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4953number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4954
4955Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4956printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4957
4958@table @code
4959@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4960@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4961Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4962offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4963@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4964to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4965
4966@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4967@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4968Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4969symbolic address.
4970@end table
4971
4972@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4973@cindex pointer, finding referent
4974If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4975@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4976and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4977@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4978For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4979at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4980
4981@example
4982(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4983(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4984$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4985@end example
4986
4987@quotation
4988@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4989does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4990the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4991@end quotation
4992
4993Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4994
4995@table @code
4996@kindex set print array
4997@item set print array
4998@itemx set print array on
4999Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5000but uses more space. The default is off.
5001
5002@item set print array off
5003Return to compressed format for arrays.
5004
5005@kindex show print array
5006@item show print array
5007Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5008arrays.
5009
5010@kindex set print elements
5011@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5012Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5013If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5014printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5015This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5016When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5017Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5018
5019@kindex show print elements
5020@item show print elements
5021Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5022If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5023
5024@kindex set print null-stop
5025@item set print null-stop
5026Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5027@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5028contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5029The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5030
5031@kindex set print pretty
5032@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5033Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5034per line, like this:
5035
5036@smallexample
5037@group
5038$1 = @{
5039 next = 0x0,
5040 flags = @{
5041 sweet = 1,
5042 sour = 1
5043 @},
5044 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5045@}
5046@end group
5047@end smallexample
5048
5049@item set print pretty off
5050Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5051
5052@smallexample
5053@group
5054$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5055meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5056@end group
5057@end smallexample
5058
5059@noindent
5060This is the default format.
5061
5062@kindex show print pretty
5063@item show print pretty
5064Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5065
5066@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5067@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5068Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5069@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5070character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5071best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5072high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5073
5074@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5075Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5076international character sets, and is the default.
5077
5078@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5079@item show print sevenbit-strings
5080Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5081
5082@kindex set print union
5083@item set print union on
5d161b24 5084Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5085is the default setting.
5086
5087@item set print union off
5088Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5089
5090@kindex show print union
5091@item show print union
5092Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5093structures.
5094
5095For example, given the declarations
5096
5097@smallexample
5098typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5099typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5100typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5101 Bug_forms;
5102
5103struct thing @{
5104 Species it;
5105 union @{
5106 Tree_forms tree;
5107 Bug_forms bug;
5108 @} form;
5109@};
5110
5111struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5112@end smallexample
5113
5114@noindent
5115with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5116
5117@smallexample
5118$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5119@end smallexample
5120
5121@noindent
5122and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5123
5124@smallexample
5125$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5126@end smallexample
5127@end table
5128
c906108c
SS
5129@need 1000
5130@noindent
5131These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5132
5133@table @code
5134@cindex demangling
5135@kindex set print demangle
5136@item set print demangle
5137@itemx set print demangle on
5138Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5139(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5140linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5141
5142@kindex show print demangle
5143@item show print demangle
5144Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5145
5146@kindex set print asm-demangle
5147@item set print asm-demangle
5148@itemx set print asm-demangle on
5149Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5150in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5151The default is off.
5152
5153@kindex show print asm-demangle
5154@item show print asm-demangle
5155Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5156or demangled form.
5157
5158@kindex set demangle-style
5159@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5160@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5161@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5162Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5163represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5164
5165@table @code
5166@item auto
5167Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5168
5169@item gnu
5d161b24 5170Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5171This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5172
5173@item hp
5174Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5175
5176@item lucid
5177Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5178
5179@item arm
5180Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5181@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5182debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5183require further enhancement to permit that.
5184
5185@end table
5186If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5187
5188@kindex show demangle-style
5189@item show demangle-style
5190Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5191
5192@kindex set print object
5193@item set print object
5194@itemx set print object on
5195When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5196(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5197the virtual function table.
5198
5199@item set print object off
5200Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5201virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5202
5203@kindex show print object
5204@item show print object
5205Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5206
5207@kindex set print static-members
5208@item set print static-members
5209@itemx set print static-members on
5210Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
5211
5212@item set print static-members off
5213Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5214
5215@kindex show print static-members
5216@item show print static-members
5217Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5218
5219@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5220@kindex set print vtbl
5221@item set print vtbl
5222@itemx set print vtbl on
5223Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5224(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5225ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5226
5227@item set print vtbl off
5228Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5229
5230@kindex show print vtbl
5231@item show print vtbl
5232Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5233@end table
c906108c 5234
6d2ebf8b 5235@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5236@section Value history
5237
5238@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5239Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5240@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5241Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5242(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5243When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5244since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5245symbol table.
5246
5247@cindex @code{$}
5248@cindex @code{$$}
5249@cindex history number
5250The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5251refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5252@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5253printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5254history number.
5255
5256To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5257history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5258remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5259the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5260@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5261is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5262@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5263
5264For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5265want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5266
5267@example
5268p *$
5269@end example
5270
5271If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5272to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5273
5274@example
5275p *$.next
5276@end example
5277
5278@noindent
5279You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5280command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5281
5282Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5283@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5284
5285@example
5286print x
5287set x=5
5288@end example
5289
5290@noindent
5291then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5292remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5293
5294@table @code
5295@kindex show values
5296@item show values
5297Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5298This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5299values} does not change the history.
5300
5301@item show values @var{n}
5302Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5303
5304@item show values +
5305Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5306values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5307@end table
5308
5309Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5310same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5311
6d2ebf8b 5312@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5313@section Convenience variables
5314
5315@cindex convenience variables
5316@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5317@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5318exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5319setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5320of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5321
5322Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5323@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5324the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5325(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5326by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5327
5328You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5329expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5330For example:
5331
5332@example
5333set $foo = *object_ptr
5334@end example
5335
5336@noindent
5337would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5338@code{object_ptr}.
5339
5340Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5341value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5342value with another assignment at any time.
5343
5344Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5345variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5346that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5347variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5348
5349@table @code
5350@kindex show convenience
5351@item show convenience
5352Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5353Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5354@end table
5355
5356One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5357incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5358a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5359
5360@example
5361set $i = 0
5362print bar[$i++]->contents
5363@end example
5364
d4f3574e
SS
5365@noindent
5366Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5367
5368Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5369values likely to be useful.
5370
5371@table @code
41afff9a 5372@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5373@item $_
5374The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5375the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5376commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5377set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5378and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5379except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5380to the type of @code{$__}.
5381
41afff9a 5382@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5383@item $__
5384The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5385to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5386to match the format in which the data was printed.
5387
5388@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5389@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5390The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5391the program being debugged terminates.
5392@end table
5393
53a5351d
JM
5394On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5395begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5396name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5397
6d2ebf8b 5398@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5399@section Registers
5400
5401@cindex registers
5402You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5403with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5404for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5405your machine.
5406
5407@table @code
5408@kindex info registers
5409@item info registers
5410Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5411registers (in the selected stack frame).
5412
5413@kindex info all-registers
5414@cindex floating point registers
5415@item info all-registers
5416Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5417registers.
5418
5419@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5420Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5421As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5422the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5423the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5424@end table
5425
5426@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5427expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5428architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5429@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5430the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5431pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5432register that contains the processor status. For example,
5433you could print the program counter in hex with
5434
5435@example
5436p/x $pc
5437@end example
5438
5439@noindent
5440or print the instruction to be executed next with
5441
5442@example
5443x/i $pc
5444@end example
5445
5446@noindent
5447or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5448one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5449memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5450stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5451stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5452regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5453see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5454
5455@example
5456set $sp += 4
5457@end example
5458
5459Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5460your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5461so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5462shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5463registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5464can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5465is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5466
5467@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5468integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5469special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5470registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5471to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5472(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5473@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5474
5475Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5476means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5477the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5478sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5479coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5480programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5481cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5482that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5483prints the data in both formats.
5484
5485Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5486(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5487value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5488were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5489true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5490frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5491
5492However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5493code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5494@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5495frame makes no difference.
5496
6d2ebf8b 5497@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5498@section Floating point hardware
5499@cindex floating point
5500
5501Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5502you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5503
5504@table @code
5505@kindex info float
5506@item info float
5507Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5508point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5509floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5510the ARM and x86 machines.
5511@end table
c906108c 5512
29e57380
C
5513@node Memory Region Attributes
5514@section Memory Region Attributes
5515@cindex memory region attributes
5516
5517@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5518required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5519to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5520use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5521
5522Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5523memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5524accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5525been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5526all memory.
5527
5528When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5529to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5530
5531@table @code
5532@kindex mem
5533@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5534Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5535with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5536
5537@kindex delete mem
5538@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5539Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5540
5541@kindex disable mem
5542@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5543Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5544A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5545It may be enabled again later.
5546
5547@kindex enable mem
5548@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5549Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5550
5551@kindex info mem
5552@item info mem
5553Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5554for each region.
5555
5556@table @emph
5557@item Memory Region Number
5558@item Enabled or Disabled.
5559Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5560Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5561
5562@item Lo Address
5563The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5564
5565@item Hi Address
5566The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5567
5568@item Attributes
5569The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5570@end table
5571@end table
5572
5573
5574@subsection Attributes
5575
5576@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5577The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5578write accesses to a memory region.
5579
5580While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5581memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5582etc. from accessing memory.
5583
5584@table @code
5585@item ro
5586Memory is read only.
5587@item wo
5588Memory is write only.
5589@item rw
5590Memory is read/write (default).
5591@end table
5592
5593@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5594The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5595accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5596require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5597specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5598
5599@table @code
5600@item 8
5601Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5602@item 16
5603Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5604@item 32
5605Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5606@item 64
5607Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5608@end table
5609
5610@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5611@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5612@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5613@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5614@c
5615@c @table @code
5616@c @item hwbreak
5617@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5618@c @item swbreak (default)
5619@c @end table
5620
5621@subsubsection Data Cache
5622The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5623memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5624protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5625does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5626registers.
5627
5628@table @code
5629@item cache
5630Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5631@item nocache (default)
5632Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5633@end table
5634
5635@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5636@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5637@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5638@c
5639@c @table @code
5640@c @item verify
5641@c @item noverify (default)
5642@c @end table
5643
6d2ebf8b 5644@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5645@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5646@cindex languages
5647
c906108c
SS
5648Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5649rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5650dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5651Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 5652represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 5653@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5654
5655@cindex working language
5656Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5657allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5658native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5659consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5660language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5661language}.
5662
5663@menu
5664* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5665* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5666* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5667* Support:: Supported languages
5668@end menu
5669
6d2ebf8b 5670@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5671@section Switching between source languages
5672
5673There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5674set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5675@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5676defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5677used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5678are printed, etc.
5679
5680In addition to the working language, every source file that
5681@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5682file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5683source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5684language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5685controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5686show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5687set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5688set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5689Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5690
5691This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 5692as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
5693another language. In that case, make the
5694program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5695@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5696program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5697
5698@menu
5699* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5700* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5701* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5702@end menu
5703
6d2ebf8b 5704@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5705@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5706
5707If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5708@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5709
5710@table @file
5711
5712@item .c
5713C source file
5714
5715@item .C
5716@itemx .cc
5717@itemx .cp
5718@itemx .cpp
5719@itemx .cxx
5720@itemx .c++
5721C++ source file
5722
5723@item .f
5724@itemx .F
5725Fortran source file
5726
c906108c
SS
5727@item .ch
5728@itemx .c186
5729@itemx .c286
96a2c332 5730CHILL source file
c906108c 5731
c906108c
SS
5732@item .mod
5733Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5734
5735@item .s
5736@itemx .S
5737Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5738@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5739@end table
5740
5741In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5742extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5743
6d2ebf8b 5744@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5745@subsection Setting the working language
5746
5747If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5748expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5749your program.
5750
5751@kindex set language
5752If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5753command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 5754a language, such as
c906108c 5755@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5756For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5757
c906108c
SS
5758Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5759language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5760to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5761source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5762languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5763source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5764command such as:
5765
5766@example
5767print a = b + c
5768@end example
5769
5770@noindent
5771might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5772@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5773printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5774@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5775
6d2ebf8b 5776@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5777@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5778
5779To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5780@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5781then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5782frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5783working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5784frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5785or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5786does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5787not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5788
5789This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5790entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5791written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5792a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5793case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5794
6d2ebf8b 5795@node Show
c906108c 5796@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5797
5798The following commands help you find out which language is the
5799working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5800
5801@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5802@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5803@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5804@table @code
5805@item show language
5806Display the current working language. This is the
5807language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5808build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5809
5810@item info frame
5d161b24 5811Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 5812working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 5813@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
5814information listed here.
5815
5816@item info source
5817Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 5818@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
5819information listed here.
5820@end table
5821
5822In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5823not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5824with a language explicitly:
5825
5826@kindex set extension-language
5827@kindex info extensions
5828@table @code
5829@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5830Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5831the source language @var{language}.
5832
5833@item info extensions
5834List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5835@end table
5836
6d2ebf8b 5837@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5838@section Type and range checking
5839
5840@quotation
5841@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5842checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5843section documents the intended facilities.
5844@end quotation
5845@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5846
5847Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5848errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5849checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5850sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5851these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5852by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5853errors when your program is running.
5854
5855@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5856Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5857can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5858the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5859@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5860your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5861for the default settings of supported languages.
5862
5863@menu
5864* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5865* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5866@end menu
5867
5868@cindex type checking
5869@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 5870@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5871@subsection An overview of type checking
5872
5873Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5874arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5875otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5876errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5877
5878@smallexample
58791 + 2 @result{} 3
5880@exdent but
5881@error{} 1 + 2.3
5882@end smallexample
5883
5884The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5885type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5886
5d161b24
DB
5887For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5888@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5889to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5890or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
5891but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5892these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5893also issues a warning.
5894
5d161b24
DB
5895Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5896related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5897For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5898a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5899with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
5900the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5901
5902Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5903instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5904operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5905represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5906operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5907details on specific languages.
5908
5909@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5910
d4f3574e 5911@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5912@kindex set check type
5913@kindex show check type
5914@table @code
5915@item set check type auto
5916Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5917@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5918each language.
5919
5920@item set check type on
5921@itemx set check type off
5922Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5923current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5924match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5925evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5926message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5927
5928@item set check type warn
5929Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5930evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5931be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5932numbers and structures.
5933
5934@item show type
5d161b24 5935Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5936is setting it automatically.
5937@end table
5938
5939@cindex range checking
5940@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 5941@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5942@subsection An overview of range checking
5943
5944In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5945bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5946checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5947computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5948not exceed the bounds of the array.
5949
5950For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5951@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5952always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5953warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5954
5955A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5956array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5957of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5958error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5959result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5960the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5961
5962@example
5963@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5964@end example
5965
5966This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5967specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5968Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5969
5970@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5971
d4f3574e 5972@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5973@kindex set check range
5974@kindex show check range
5975@table @code
5976@item set check range auto
5977Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5978@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5979each language.
5980
5981@item set check range on
5982@itemx set check range off
5983Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5984current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
5985match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5986then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
5987
5988@item set check range warn
5989Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5990but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5991expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5992memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5993systems).
5994
5995@item show range
5996Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5997being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5998@end table
c906108c 5999
6d2ebf8b 6000@node Support
c906108c 6001@section Supported languages
c906108c 6002
cce74817
JM
6003@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
6004@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6005Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6006language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6007and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6008,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6009language.
6010
6011The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6012supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6013tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6014@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6015formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6016books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6017language reference or tutorial.
6018
c906108c 6019@menu
7a292a7a 6020* C:: C and C++
cce74817 6021* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6022* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6023@end menu
6024
6d2ebf8b 6025@node C
c906108c 6026@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 6027
c906108c
SS
6028@cindex C and C++
6029@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
6030
6031Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
6032to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6033together.
6034
41afff9a
EZ
6035@cindex C@t{++}
6036@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
c906108c
SS
6037@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
6038The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
6039compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
6040effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
6041C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
6042compiler (@code{aCC}).
6043
6044For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
6045format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6046command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6047@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6048CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6049
c906108c
SS
6050@menu
6051* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
6052* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 6053* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 6054* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 6055* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6056* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
6057* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
6058@end menu
c906108c 6059
6d2ebf8b 6060@node C Operators
c906108c 6061@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
6062
6063@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
6064
6065Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6066@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6067often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6068
c906108c 6069For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6070
6071@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6072
c906108c 6073@item
c906108c
SS
6074@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
6075specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6076
6077@item
d4f3574e
SS
6078@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6079@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6080
6081@item
53a5351d 6082@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6083
6084@item
6085@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6086
c906108c
SS
6087@end itemize
6088
6089@noindent
6090The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6091in order of increasing precedence:
6092
6093@table @code
6094@item ,
6095The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6096are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6097expression being the last expression evaluated.
6098
6099@item =
6100Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6101assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6102
6103@item @var{op}=
6104Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6105and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6106@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6107@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6108@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6109
6110@item ?:
6111The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6112of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6113integral type.
6114
6115@item ||
6116Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6117
6118@item &&
6119Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6120
6121@item |
6122Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6123
6124@item ^
6125Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6126
6127@item &
6128Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6129
6130@item ==@r{, }!=
6131Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6132expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6133
6134@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6135Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6136Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6137and non-zero for true.
6138
6139@item <<@r{, }>>
6140left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6141
6142@item @@
6143The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6144
6145@item +@r{, }-
6146Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6147pointer types.
6148
6149@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6150Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6151defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6152integral types.
6153
6154@item ++@r{, }--
6155Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6156operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6157when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6158operation takes place.
6159
6160@item *
6161Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6162@code{++}.
6163
6164@item &
6165Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6166
c906108c
SS
6167For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6168allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6169(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6170where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6171stored.
c906108c
SS
6172
6173@item -
6174Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6175precedence as @code{++}.
6176
6177@item !
6178Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6179@code{++}.
6180
6181@item ~
6182Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6183@code{++}.
6184
6185
6186@item .@r{, }->
6187Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6188@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6189pointer based on the stored type information.
6190Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6191
c906108c
SS
6192@item .*@r{, }->*
6193Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6194
6195@item []
6196Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6197@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6198
6199@item ()
6200Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6201
c906108c 6202@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6203C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6204and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6205
6206@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6207Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6208(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6209above.
c906108c
SS
6210@end table
6211
c906108c
SS
6212If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6213attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6214predefined meaning.
c906108c 6215
c906108c 6216@menu
5d161b24 6217* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6218@end menu
6219
6d2ebf8b 6220@node C Constants
c906108c 6221@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
6222
6223@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 6224
7a292a7a 6225@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 6226following ways:
c906108c
SS
6227
6228@itemize @bullet
6229@item
6230Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6231specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6232a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6233@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6234@code{long} value.
6235
6236@item
6237Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6238point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6239exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6240@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6241sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6242A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6243@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6244the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6245a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6246constant.
c906108c
SS
6247
6248@item
6249Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6250integral equivalents.
6251
6252@item
6253Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6254(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6255(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6256be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6257the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6258of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6259@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6260@samp{\n} for newline.
6261
6262@item
96a2c332
SS
6263String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6264double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6265above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6266a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6267characters.
c906108c
SS
6268
6269@item
6270Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6271to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6272
6273@item
6274Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6275and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6276integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6277and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6278@end itemize
6279
c906108c 6280@menu
5d161b24
DB
6281* C plus plus expressions::
6282* C Defaults::
6283* C Checks::
c906108c 6284
5d161b24 6285* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6286@end menu
6287
6d2ebf8b 6288@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 6289@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
6290
6291@cindex expressions in C++
6292@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6293
c906108c
SS
6294@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6295@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6296@cindex C++ and object formats
6297@cindex object formats and C++
6298@cindex a.out and C++
6299@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6300@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6301@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6302@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6303@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6304@c periodically whether this has happened...
6305@quotation
6306@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6307proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6308additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6309special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6310@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6311symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6312you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6313extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6314@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6315support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6316@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6317
6318@enumerate
6319
6320@cindex member functions
6321@item
6322Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6323
6324@example
6325count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6326@end example
6327
41afff9a 6328@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
c906108c
SS
6329@cindex namespace in C++
6330@item
6331While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6332expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6333that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6334pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6335
c906108c 6336@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6337@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
6338@cindex type conversions in C++
6339@item
6340You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6341call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6342perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6343calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6344in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6345default arguments.
6346
6347It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6348promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6349class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6350functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6351number of function arguments.
6352
6353Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6354@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6355,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6356
d4f3574e 6357You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6358explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6359@smallexample
6360p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6361@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6362
c906108c 6363The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6364see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6365
c906108c
SS
6366@cindex reference declarations
6367@item
5d161b24 6368@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
c906108c
SS
6369them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6370dereferenced.
6371
6372In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6373reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6374avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6375The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6376you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6377
6378@item
6379@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6380expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6381one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6382necessary, for example in an expression like
6383@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6384resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6385debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6386@end enumerate
6387
53a5351d
JM
6388In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6389calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6390objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6391invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 6392
6d2ebf8b 6393@node C Defaults
c906108c 6394@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6395
c906108c
SS
6396@cindex C and C++ defaults
6397
c906108c
SS
6398If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6399both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6400C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6401selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6402
6403If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6404recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6405@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6406these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6407@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6408for further details.
6409
c906108c
SS
6410@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6411@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6412@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6413
6d2ebf8b 6414@node C Checks
c906108c 6415@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6416
c906108c
SS
6417@cindex C and C++ checks
6418
6419By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6420is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6421considers two variables type equivalent if:
6422
6423@itemize @bullet
6424@item
6425The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6426enumerated tag.
6427
6428@item
6429The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6430declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6431
6432@ignore
6433@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6434@c FIXME--beers?
6435@item
6436The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6437declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6438compilers.)
6439@end ignore
6440@end itemize
6441
6442Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6443indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6444that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6445
6d2ebf8b 6446@node Debugging C
c906108c 6447@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6448
6449The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6450the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6451inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6452appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6453
6454The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6455with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6456,Expressions}.
6457
c906108c 6458@menu
5d161b24 6459* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
6460@end menu
6461
6d2ebf8b 6462@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6463@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6464
6465@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6466
c906108c
SS
6467Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6468designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6469
6470@table @code
6471@cindex break in overloaded functions
6472@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6473When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6474@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6475you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6476
6477@cindex overloading in C++
6478@item rbreak @var{regex}
6479Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6480breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6481classes.
6482@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6483
6484@cindex C++ exception handling
6485@item catch throw
6486@itemx catch catch
6487Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6488Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6489
6490@cindex inheritance
6491@item ptype @var{typename}
6492Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6493@var{typename}.
6494@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6495
6496@cindex C++ symbol display
6497@item set print demangle
6498@itemx show print demangle
6499@itemx set print asm-demangle
6500@itemx show print asm-demangle
6501Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6502displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6503@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6504
6505@item set print object
6506@itemx show print object
6507Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6508@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6509
6510@item set print vtbl
6511@itemx show print vtbl
6512Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6513@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6514(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6515ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6516
6517@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6518@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6519@item set overload-resolution on
6520Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6521is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6522and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6523using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6524expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6525message.
6526
6527@item set overload-resolution off
6528Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6529overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6530chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6531symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6532overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6533searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6534argument types.
c906108c
SS
6535
6536@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6537You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6538the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6539@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6540also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6541available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6542@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6543@end table
c906108c 6544
6d2ebf8b 6545@node Modula-2
c906108c 6546@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6547
d4f3574e 6548@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6549
6550The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6551output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6552developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6553attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6554to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6555table.
6556
6557@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6558@menu
6559* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6560* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6561* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6562* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6563* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6564* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6565* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6566* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6567@end menu
6568
6d2ebf8b 6569@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6570@subsubsection Operators
6571@cindex Modula-2 operators
6572
6573Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6574@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6575often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6576following definitions hold:
6577
6578@itemize @bullet
6579
6580@item
6581@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6582their subranges.
6583
6584@item
6585@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6586
6587@item
6588@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6589
6590@item
6591@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6592@var{type}}.
6593
6594@item
6595@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6596
6597@item
6598@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6599
6600@item
6601@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6602@end itemize
6603
6604@noindent
6605The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6606increasing precedence:
6607
6608@table @code
6609@item ,
6610Function argument or array index separator.
6611
6612@item :=
6613Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6614@var{value}.
6615
6616@item <@r{, }>
6617Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6618types.
6619
6620@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 6621Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
6622on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6623set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6624
6625@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6626Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6627Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6628available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6629comment character.
6630
6631@item IN
6632Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6633Same precedence as @code{<}.
6634
6635@item OR
6636Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6637
6638@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6639Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6640
6641@item @@
6642The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6643
6644@item +@r{, }-
6645Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6646and difference on set types.
6647
6648@item *
6649Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6650on set types.
6651
6652@item /
6653Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6654types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6655
6656@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6657Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6658precedence as @code{*}.
6659
6660@item -
6661Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6662
6663@item ^
6664Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6665
6666@item NOT
6667Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6668@code{^}.
6669
6670@item .
6671@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6672precedence as @code{^}.
6673
6674@item []
6675Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6676
6677@item ()
6678Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6679as @code{^}.
6680
6681@item ::@r{, }.
6682@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6683@end table
6684
6685@quotation
6686@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6687treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6688@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6689@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6690@end quotation
6691
6692@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6d2ebf8b 6693@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6694@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6695
6696Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6697In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6698
6699@table @var
6700
6701@item a
6702represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6703
6704@item c
6705represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6706
6707@item i
6708represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6709
6710@item m
6711represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6712same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6713be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6714
6715@item n
6716represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6717
6718@item r
6719represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6720
6721@item t
6722represents a type.
6723
6724@item v
6725represents a variable.
6726
6727@item x
6728represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6729explanation of the function for details.
6730@end table
6731
6732All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6733
6734@table @code
6735@item ABS(@var{n})
6736Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6737
6738@item CAP(@var{c})
6739If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 6740equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
6741
6742@item CHR(@var{i})
6743Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6744
6745@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6746Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6747
6748@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6749Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6750new value.
6751
6752@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6753Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6754set.
6755
6756@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6757Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6758
6759@item HIGH(@var{a})
6760Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6761
6762@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6763Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6764
6765@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6766Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6767new value.
6768
6769@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6770Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6771there. Returns the new set.
6772
6773@item MAX(@var{t})
6774Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6775
6776@item MIN(@var{t})
6777Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6778
6779@item ODD(@var{i})
6780Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6781
6782@item ORD(@var{x})
6783Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
6784value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6785@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
6786integral, character and enumerated types.
6787
6788@item SIZE(@var{x})
6789Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6790
6791@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6792Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6793
6794@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6795Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6796@end table
6797
6798@quotation
6799@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6800@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6801an error.
6802@end quotation
6803
6804@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 6805@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6806@subsubsection Constants
6807
6808@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6809ways:
6810
6811@itemize @bullet
6812
6813@item
6814Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6815expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6816rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6817trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6818
6819@item
6820Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6821decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6822then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6823@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6824digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6825digits.
6826
6827@item
6828Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6829like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 6830also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
6831followed by a @samp{C}.
6832
6833@item
6834String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6835pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6836Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6837Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6838sequences.
6839
6840@item
6841Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6842
6843@item
6844Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6845@code{FALSE}.
6846
6847@item
6848Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6849
6850@item
6851Set constants are not yet supported.
6852@end itemize
6853
6d2ebf8b 6854@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6855@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6856@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6857
6858If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6859both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6860Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6861selected the working language.
6862
6863If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6864code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6865working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6866the language automatically}, for further details.
6867
6d2ebf8b 6868@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6869@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6870@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6871
6872A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6873This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6874
6875@itemize @bullet
6876@item
6877Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6878integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6879debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6880pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6881through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6882returned a pointer.)
6883
6884@item
6885C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6886non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6887escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6888printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6889
6890@item
6891The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6892argument.
6893
6894@item
6895All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6896@end itemize
6897
6d2ebf8b 6898@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6899@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6900@cindex Modula-2 checks
6901
6902@quotation
6903@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6904range checking.
6905@end quotation
6906@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6907
6908@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6909
6910@itemize @bullet
6911@item
6912They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6913@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6914
6915@item
6916They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6917@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6918@end itemize
6919
6920As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6921whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6922
6923Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6924index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6925
6d2ebf8b 6926@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6927@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6928@cindex scope
41afff9a 6929@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
6930@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6931@ifinfo
41afff9a 6932@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6933@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6934@end ifinfo
6935@iftex
41afff9a 6936@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6937@end iftex
6938
6939There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6940(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6941similar syntax:
6942
6943@example
6944
6945@var{module} . @var{id}
6946@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6947@end example
6948
6949@noindent
6950where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6951@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6952identifier within your program, except another module.
6953
6954Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6955specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6956found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6957enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6958
6959Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6960the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6961definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6962an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6963module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6964@var{module}.
6965
6d2ebf8b 6966@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6967@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6968
6969Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6970Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6971specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6972@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6973apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6974analogue in Modula-2.
6975
6976The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6977with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6978intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6979created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6980address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6981@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6982
6983@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6984In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6985interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6986
6d2ebf8b 6987@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6988@subsection Chill
6989
6990The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6991from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6992supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6993likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6994table.
6995
d4f3574e
SS
6996@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6997@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6998This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6999of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7000
7001@menu
104c1213
JM
7002* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7003* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 7004* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7005* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7006* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7007@end menu
7008
6d2ebf8b 7009@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7010@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7011
7012The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7013with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7014slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7015provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7016
7017@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7018@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7019@table @code
7020@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7021@itemize @bullet
7022@item
7023@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7024UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7025@item
5d161b24 7026@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7027@item
5d161b24 7028@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7029@item
7030@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7031@smallexample
7032(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7033type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7034@end smallexample
7035If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7036@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7037@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7038@smallexample
7039@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7040@end smallexample
7041where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7042expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7043@end itemize
7044
7045@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7046A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7047the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7048@smallexample
7049(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7050type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7051@end smallexample
7052
7053@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7054@itemize @bullet
7055@item
d4f3574e 7056@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7057followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7058@item
7059@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7060@end itemize
7061
7062@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7063The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7064<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7065list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7066the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7067all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7068
7069@ignore
7070@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7071The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7072type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7073@end ignore
7074
5d161b24 7075@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7076@itemize @bullet
7077@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7078@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7079@smallexample
7080@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7081@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7082where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7083@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7084@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7085@smallexample
7086@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7087@end smallexample
7088where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7089@end itemize
7090
5d161b24 7091@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7092@itemize @bullet
7093@item
7094@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7095@item
7096@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7097@end itemize
7098
7099@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7100Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7101
7102@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7103@itemize @bullet
7104@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7105@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7106@smallexample
7107@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7108@end smallexample
7109followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7110mode
cce74817 7111@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7112@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7113@smallexample
7114@code{BOOLS(<string
7115length>)}
7116@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7117@end itemize
7118
7119@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7120The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7121followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7122@smallexample
7123(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7124type = ARRAY (1:42)
7125 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7126 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7127@end smallexample
7128
5d161b24 7129@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7130The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7131list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7132of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7133OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7134of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7135checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7136always displays all variant fields.
7137@smallexample
7138(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7139type = STRUCT (
7140 as x,
7141 bs x,
7142 CASE bs OF
7143 (karli):
7144 cs a
7145 (ott):
7146 ds x
7147 ESAC
7148)
7149@end smallexample
7150@end table
7151
6d2ebf8b 7152@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7153@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7154
7155A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7156
7157A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7158the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7159Chill programs. How values are specified
7160is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7161
7162The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7163display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7164
cce74817
JM
7165@smallexample
7166set result := EXPR
7167@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7168
7169@noindent
7170This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7171is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7172
7173Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7174value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7175mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7176represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7177value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7178operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7179
6d2ebf8b
SS
7180Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7181@smallexample
7182@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7183(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7184location>}
7185@end smallexample
7186@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7187specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7188the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7189
7190@ignore
7191Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7192fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7193the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7194implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7195na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7196<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7197@code{__proc_copy}.
7198
7199Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7200the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7201like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7202mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7203
7204Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7205...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7206definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7207of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7208structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7209braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7210on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7211memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7212all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7213@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7214stuff ???)
7215@smallexample
7216(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7217[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7218@end smallexample
7219@end ignore
7220
7221Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7222(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7223certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7224and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7225
7226A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7227location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7228name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7229have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7230checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7231therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7232
cce74817
JM
7233@smallexample
7234(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7235@end smallexample
7236
6d2ebf8b 7237@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7238@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7239
7240Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7241more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7242data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7243such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7244constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7245when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7246(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7247the values behind these locations.
7248
d4f3574e 7249This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7250operations are legal to be used with such values.
7251
7252@table @code
7253@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7254Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7255For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7256chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7257@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7258@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7259
5d161b24 7260@ignore
cce74817
JM
7261@itemize @bullet
7262@item
7263@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7264programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7265@item
7266@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7267@item
7268@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7269@code{'M'})
7270@item
7271@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
7272mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7273comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 7274@item
d4f3574e 7275@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7276emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7277procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7278
7279@item
7280@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7281enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7282to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7283@item
7284@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7285programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7286@item
7287@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7288(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7289@end itemize
7290@end ignore
7291
7292@item Tuple Values
7293A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7294name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7295unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7296@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7297
cce74817
JM
7298@itemize @bullet
7299@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7300@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7301@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7302Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7303same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7304@end itemize
7305
7306@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7307A string element value is specified by
7308@smallexample
7309@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7310@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7311where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7312value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7313the string.
7314
7315@item String Slice Value
7316A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7317spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7318expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7319@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7320The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7321string.
7322
7323@item Array Element Values
7324An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7325delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7326
7327@item Array Slice Values
7328An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7329@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7330@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7331arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7332which is part of the specified array.
7333
7334@item Structure Field Values
7335A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7336name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7337in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7338corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7339
7340@item Procedure Call Value
7341The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7342procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7343expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7344effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7345
d4f3574e 7346Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7347
6d2ebf8b
SS
7348Values of time mode locations appear as
7349@smallexample
7350@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7351@end smallexample
7352
cce74817
JM
7353
7354@ignore
7355This is not implemented yet:
7356@item Built-in Value
7357@noindent
7358The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7359
cce74817
JM
7360@table @code
7361@item @code{ADDR()}
7362@item @code{NUM()}
7363@item @code{PRED()}
7364@item @code{SUCC()}
7365@item @code{ABS()}
7366@item @code{CARD()}
7367@item @code{MAX()}
7368@item @code{MIN()}
7369@item @code{SIZE()}
7370@item @code{UPPER()}
7371@item @code{LOWER()}
7372@item @code{LENGTH()}
7373@item @code{SIN()}
7374@item @code{COS()}
7375@item @code{TAN()}
7376@item @code{ARCSIN()}
7377@item @code{ARCCOS()}
7378@item @code{ARCTAN()}
7379@item @code{EXP()}
7380@item @code{LN()}
7381@item @code{LOG()}
7382@item @code{SQRT()}
7383@end table
7384
7385For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7386chapter 1.6.
7387@end ignore
7388
7389@item Zero-adic Operator Value
7390The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7391current active process.
7392
7393@item Expression Values
7394The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 7395the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 7396incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 7397corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 7398causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 7399which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 7400operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 7401
cce74817
JM
7402@table @code
7403@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7404@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7405@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7406Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 7407
cce74817
JM
7408@item @code{=, /=}
7409Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 7410
cce74817 7411@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7412@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7413Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7414
cce74817 7415@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 7416@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 7417Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7418
cce74817
JM
7419@item @code{-}
7420Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7421
cce74817
JM
7422@item @code{//}
7423String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7424
cce74817
JM
7425@item @code{()}
7426String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7427
cce74817
JM
7428@item @code{->}
7429Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7430address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7431location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7432
cce74817 7433@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7434@itemx @code{AND}
7435@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7436Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7437
cce74817 7438@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7439@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7440Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7441
cce74817
JM
7442@item @code{IN}
7443Membership operator.
7444@end table
7445@end table
7446
6d2ebf8b 7447@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7448@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7449
7450@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7451of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7452complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7453equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7454structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7455
7456Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7457index bounds and all built in procedures.
7458
7459Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7460check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7461operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7462functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7463language specification.
7464
cce74817
JM
7465All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7466off}.
7467
5d161b24 7468@ignore
53a5351d 7469@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7470see last paragraph ?
7471@end ignore
7472
6d2ebf8b 7473@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7474@subsubsection Chill defaults
7475
7476If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7477both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7478Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7479selected the working language.
7480
7481If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7482code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7483working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7484the language automatically}, for further details.
7485
6d2ebf8b 7486@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7487@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7488
d4f3574e 7489The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7490symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7491program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7492does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7493program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7494(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7495file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7496
7497@cindex symbol names
7498@cindex names of symbols
7499@cindex quoting names
7500Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7501characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7502most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7503source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7504are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7505ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7506@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7507@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7508
7509@example
7510p 'foo.c'::x
7511@end example
7512
7513@noindent
7514looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7515
7516@table @code
7517@kindex info address
7518@item info address @var{symbol}
7519Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7520variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7521local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7522is always stored.
7523
7524Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7525at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7526the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7527
3d67e040
EZ
7528@kindex info symbol
7529@item info symbol @var{addr}
7530Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
7531If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
7532nearest symbol and an offset from it:
7533
7534@example
7535(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
7536_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
7537@end example
7538
7539@noindent
7540This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
7541it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
7542
c906108c 7543@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7544@item whatis @var{expr}
7545Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7546actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7547assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7548@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7549
7550@item whatis
7551Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7552
7553@kindex ptype
7554@item ptype @var{typename}
7555Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7556the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7557@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7558@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7559
d4f3574e 7560@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7561@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7562Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7563differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7564of just the name of the type.
7565
7566For example, for this variable declaration:
7567
7568@example
7569struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7570@end example
7571
7572@noindent
7573the two commands give this output:
7574
7575@example
7576@group
7577(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7578type = struct complex
7579(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7580type = struct complex @{
7581 double real;
7582 double imag;
7583@}
7584@end group
7585@end example
7586
7587@noindent
7588As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7589the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7590
7591@kindex info types
7592@item info types @var{regexp}
7593@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7594Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7595(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7596complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7597@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7598names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7599information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7600
7601This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7602@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7603lists all source files where a type is defined.
7604
7605@kindex info source
7606@item info source
7607Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7608the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7609it was written in.
7610
7611@kindex info sources
7612@item info sources
7613Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7614debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7615have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7616
7617@kindex info functions
7618@item info functions
7619Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7620
7621@item info functions @var{regexp}
7622Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7623whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7624Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7625include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7626start with @code{step}.
7627
7628@kindex info variables
7629@item info variables
7630Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7631outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7632
7633@item info variables @var{regexp}
7634Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7635variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7636@var{regexp}.
7637
7638@ignore
7639This was never implemented.
7640@kindex info methods
7641@item info methods
7642@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7643The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7644methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7645specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7646C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7647from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7648@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7649which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7650@end ignore
7651
c906108c
SS
7652@cindex reloading symbols
7653Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7654be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7655in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7656running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7657@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7658
7659@table @code
7660@kindex set symbol-reloading
7661@item set symbol-reloading on
7662Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7663object file with a particular name is seen again.
7664
7665@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
7666Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
7667same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
7668running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
7669should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
7670may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
7671several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
7672name.
c906108c
SS
7673
7674@kindex show symbol-reloading
7675@item show symbol-reloading
7676Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7677@end table
c906108c 7678
c906108c
SS
7679@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7680@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7681Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7682declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7683@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7684source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7685another source file. The default is on.
7686
7687A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7688the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7689
7690@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7691Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7692is printed as follows:
7693@smallexample
7694@{<no data fields>@}
7695@end smallexample
7696
7697@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7698@item show opaque-type-resolution
7699Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7700
7701@kindex maint print symbols
7702@cindex symbol dump
7703@kindex maint print psymbols
7704@cindex partial symbol dump
7705@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7706@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7707@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7708Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7709These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7710symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7711symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7712collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7713only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7714command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7715use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7716symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7717files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7718@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7719required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7720@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7721@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7722@end table
7723
6d2ebf8b 7724@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7725@chapter Altering Execution
7726
7727Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7728find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7729correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7730experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7731program.
7732
7733For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7734locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7735address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7736
7737@menu
7738* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7739* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7740* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7741* Returning:: Returning from a function
7742* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7743* Patching:: Patching your program
7744@end menu
7745
6d2ebf8b 7746@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7747@section Assignment to variables
7748
7749@cindex assignment
7750@cindex setting variables
7751To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7752@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7753
7754@example
7755print x=4
7756@end example
7757
7758@noindent
7759stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 7760value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7761@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7762information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7763
7764@kindex set variable
7765@cindex variables, setting
7766If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7767@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7768really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7769not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7770,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7771
c906108c
SS
7772If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7773appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7774variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7775to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7776program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7777a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7778command @code{set width}:
7779
7780@example
7781(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7782type = double
7783(@value{GDBP}) p width
7784$4 = 13
7785(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7786Invalid syntax in expression.
7787@end example
7788
7789@noindent
7790The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7791order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7792
7793@example
7794(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7795@end example
53a5351d 7796
c906108c
SS
7797Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7798with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7799@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7800your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7801to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7802the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7803
7804@example
7805@group
7806(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7807type = double
7808(@value{GDBP}) p g
7809$1 = 1
7810(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 7811(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
7812$2 = 1
7813(@value{GDBP}) r
7814The program being debugged has been started already.
7815Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7816Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
7817"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
7818 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
7819(@value{GDBP}) show g
7820The current BFD target is "=4".
7821@end group
7822@end example
7823
7824@noindent
7825The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7826@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7827@code{g}, use
7828
7829@example
7830(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7831@end example
c906108c
SS
7832
7833@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7834freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7835and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7836same length or shorter.
7837@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7838@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7839
7840To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7841construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7842(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7843to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7844and representation in memory), and
7845
7846@example
7847set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7848@end example
7849
7850@noindent
7851stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7852
6d2ebf8b 7853@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7854@section Continuing at a different address
7855
7856Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7857it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7858an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7859
7860@table @code
7861@kindex jump
7862@item jump @var{linespec}
7863Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7864immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7865source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7866@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7867in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7868breakpoints}.
7869
7870The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7871the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7872register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7873a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7874be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7875of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7876confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7877executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7878well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7879
7880@item jump *@var{address}
7881Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7882@end table
7883
c906108c 7884@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7885On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7886command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7887difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7888changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7889example,
c906108c
SS
7890
7891@example
7892set $pc = 0x485
7893@end example
7894
7895@noindent
7896makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7897address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7898@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7899
7900The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7901up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7902that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7903detail.
7904
c906108c 7905@c @group
6d2ebf8b 7906@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7907@section Giving your program a signal
7908
7909@table @code
7910@kindex signal
7911@item signal @var{signal}
7912Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7913signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7914signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7915SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7916
7917Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7918giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7919a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7920@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7921signal.
7922
7923@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7924after executing the command.
7925@end table
7926@c @end group
7927
7928Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7929@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7930causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7931the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7932passes the signal directly to your program.
7933
c906108c 7934
6d2ebf8b 7935@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7936@section Returning from a function
7937
7938@table @code
7939@cindex returning from a function
7940@kindex return
7941@item return
7942@itemx return @var{expression}
7943You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7944command. If you give an
7945@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7946value.
7947@end table
7948
7949When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7950(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7951discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7952be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7953
7954This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7955frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7956innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7957specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7958of functions.
7959
7960The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7961program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7962returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7963and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7964selected stack frame returns naturally.
7965
6d2ebf8b 7966@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7967@section Calling program functions
7968
7969@cindex calling functions
7970@kindex call
7971@table @code
7972@item call @var{expr}
7973Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7974returned values.
7975@end table
7976
7977You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7978execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
7979with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7980is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 7981
c906108c
SS
7982For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7983specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7984calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7985method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7986that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7987
6d2ebf8b 7988@node Patching
c906108c 7989@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7990
c906108c
SS
7991@cindex patching binaries
7992@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7993@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7994
7a292a7a
SS
7995By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7996executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7997alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7998patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7999
8000If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8001explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8002want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8003repairs.
8004
8005@table @code
8006@kindex set write
8007@item set write on
8008@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
8009If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8010core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
8011off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8012
8013If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
8014@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8015write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
8016
8017@item show write
8018@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
8019Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8020as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8021@end table
8022
6d2ebf8b 8023@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8024@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8025
7a292a7a
SS
8026@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8027both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8028program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8029@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8030
8031@menu
8032* Files:: Commands to specify files
8033* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8034@end menu
8035
6d2ebf8b 8036@node Files
c906108c 8037@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8038
7a292a7a 8039@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8040@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8041
8042You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8043way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8044@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8045Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8046
8047Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8048@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8049a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8050to specify new files are useful.
8051
8052@table @code
8053@cindex executable file
8054@kindex file
8055@item file @var{filename}
8056Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8057symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8058executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8059directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8060@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8061directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8062to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8063and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8064
6d2ebf8b 8065On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8066@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8067@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8068@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8069descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8070(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8071@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8072for more information.
c906108c
SS
8073
8074@item file
8075@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8076has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8077
8078@kindex exec-file
8079@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8080Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8081in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8082if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8083discard information on the executable file.
8084
8085@kindex symbol-file
8086@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8087Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8088searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8089table and program to run from the same file.
8090
8091@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8092program's symbol table.
8093
5d161b24 8094The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8095of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8096auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8097the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8098the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8099
8100@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8101executing it once.
8102
8103When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8104understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8105generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8106other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8107Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8108using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8109optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8110
8111For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8112using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8113symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8114quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8115details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8116
8117The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8118start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8119occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8120file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8121pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8122warnings and messages}.)
8123
c906108c
SS
8124We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8125symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8126symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8127still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8128in stabs format.
8129
8130@kindex readnow
8131@cindex reading symbols immediately
8132@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8133@kindex mapped
8134@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8135@cindex saving symbol table
8136@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8137@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8138You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8139tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8140load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8141entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8142
c906108c
SS
8143If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8144@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8145cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8146file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8147from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8148than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8149program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8150starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8151
8152You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8153file has all the symbol information for your program.
8154
8155The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8156@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8157than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8158it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8159needed.
8160
8161The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8162@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8163symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8164
8165@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8166@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8167@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8168@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8169@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8170@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8171@c files.
8172
8173@kindex core
8174@kindex core-file
8175@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8176Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8177of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8178address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8179executable file itself for other parts.
8180
8181@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8182to be used.
8183
8184Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8185under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8186wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8187the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8188(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8189
c906108c
SS
8190@kindex add-symbol-file
8191@cindex dynamic linking
8192@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8193@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8194@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8195The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8196information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8197when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8198into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8199address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8200this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8201of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8202section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8203@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8204
8205The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8206originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8207@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8208thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8209instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8210
8211@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8212
8213You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8214the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8215table information for @var{filename}.
8216
8217@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8218@item add-shared-symbol-file
8219The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8220operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8221shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8222@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8223
c906108c
SS
8224@kindex section
8225@item section
5d161b24
DB
8226The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8227the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8228section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8229specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8230separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8231the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8232
8233@kindex info files
8234@kindex info target
8235@item info files
8236@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8237@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8238current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8239including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8240use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8241command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8242current ones.
8243
c906108c
SS
8244@end table
8245
8246All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8247as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8248name and remembers it that way.
8249
c906108c 8250@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8251@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8252libraries.
53a5351d 8253
c906108c
SS
8254@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8255when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8256(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8257references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8258debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8259
8260On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8261automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8262
c906108c
SS
8263@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8264@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8265@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8266
8267@table @code
8268@kindex info sharedlibrary
8269@kindex info share
8270@item info share
8271@itemx info sharedlibrary
8272Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8273
8274@kindex sharedlibrary
8275@kindex share
8276@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8277@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8278Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8279Unix regular expression.
8280As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8281required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8282@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8283loaded.
8284@end table
8285
53a5351d
JM
8286On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8287and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8288a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8289
8290Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8291loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8292@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8293automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8294
8295To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8296
8297@table @code
8298@kindex set auto-solib-add
8299@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8300Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8301nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8302automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8303linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8304the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8305Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8306@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8307
8308@kindex show auto-solib-add
8309@item show auto-solib-add
8310Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8311@end table
c906108c 8312
6d2ebf8b 8313@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8314@section Errors reading symbol files
8315
8316While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8317such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8318output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8319they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8320debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8321about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8322only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8323times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8324to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8325complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8326messages}).
8327
8328The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8329
8330@table @code
8331@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8332
8333The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8334(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8335error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8336in its outer scope blocks.
8337
8338@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8339the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8340may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8341function.
8342
8343@item block at @var{address} out of order
8344
8345The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8346order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8347do so.
8348
8349@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8350locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8351can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8352@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8353messages}.)
8354
8355@item bad block start address patched
8356
8357The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8358smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
8359to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8360
8361@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8362starting on the previous source line.
8363
8364@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8365
8366@cindex foo
8367Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8368larger than the size of the string table.
8369
8370@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8371name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8372with this name.
8373
8374@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8375
7a292a7a
SS
8376The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8377not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 8378uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 8379
7a292a7a
SS
8380@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8381This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 8382are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
8383debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8384on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8385and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
8386
8387@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 8388
7a292a7a 8389@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 8390
7a292a7a 8391@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 8392The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
8393information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8394it.
c906108c
SS
8395
8396@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8397
8398@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 8399
c906108c
SS
8400@end table
8401
6d2ebf8b 8402@node Targets
c906108c 8403@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 8404
c906108c
SS
8405@cindex debugging target
8406@kindex target
8407
8408A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
8409
8410Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8411in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8412you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
8413flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8414host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
8415realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8416command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8417(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
8418
8419@menu
8420* Active Targets:: Active targets
8421* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
8422* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8423* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 8424* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
8425
8426@end menu
8427
6d2ebf8b 8428@node Active Targets
c906108c 8429@section Active targets
7a292a7a 8430
c906108c
SS
8431@cindex stacking targets
8432@cindex active targets
8433@cindex multiple targets
8434
c906108c 8435There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
8436executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8437active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8438start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8439a core file.
c906108c
SS
8440
8441For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8442@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8443well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8444@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8445first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8446requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8447are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8448read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8449executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8450
8451When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8452target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8453commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8454an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8455process target is active.
c906108c 8456
7a292a7a
SS
8457Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8458core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8459files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8460the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8461process}).
c906108c 8462
6d2ebf8b 8463@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8464@section Commands for managing targets
8465
8466@table @code
8467@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8468Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8469process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8470facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8471protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8472
8473Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8474typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8475with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8476
8477The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8478after executing the command.
8479
8480@kindex help target
8481@item help target
8482Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8483currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8484(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8485
8486@item help target @var{name}
8487Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8488select it.
8489
8490@kindex set gnutarget
8491@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 8492@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8493knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
8494a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8495with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
8496with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8497
d4f3574e 8498@quotation
c906108c
SS
8499@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8500you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8501@end quotation
c906108c 8502
d4f3574e
SS
8503@noindent
8504@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 8505
5d161b24 8506@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
8507@item show gnutarget
8508Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8509@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8510@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8511and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8512@end table
8513
c906108c
SS
8514Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8515configuration):
c906108c
SS
8516
8517@table @code
8518@kindex target exec
8519@item target exec @var{program}
8520An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8521@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8522
c906108c
SS
8523@kindex target core
8524@item target core @var{filename}
8525A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8526@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8527
8528@kindex target remote
8529@item target remote @var{dev}
8530Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8531specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8532@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8533supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8534some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8535it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8536
c906108c
SS
8537@kindex target sim
8538@item target sim
2df3850c 8539Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
8540In general,
8541@example
8542 target sim
8543 load
8544 run
8545@end example
d4f3574e 8546@noindent
104c1213 8547works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8548drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8549provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8550see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8551Processors}.
8552
c906108c
SS
8553@end table
8554
104c1213 8555Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8556
8557@table @code
8558
c906108c
SS
8559@kindex target nrom
8560@item target nrom @var{dev}
8561NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8562
c906108c
SS
8563@end table
8564
5d161b24 8565Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 8566your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8567
8568Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8569once you've successfully established a connection.
8570
8571@table @code
8572
8573@kindex load @var{filename}
8574@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8575Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8576@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8577is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8578on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8579@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8580the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8581
8582If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8583execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8584target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8585
8586The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8587For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8588link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8589specifies a fixed address.
8590@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8591
c906108c
SS
8592@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8593@end table
8594
6d2ebf8b 8595@node Byte Order
c906108c 8596@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8597
c906108c
SS
8598@cindex choosing target byte order
8599@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
8600
8601Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8602offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8603orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8604designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8605which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8606@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8607
8608@table @code
8609@kindex set endian big
8610@item set endian big
8611Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8612
8613@kindex set endian little
8614@item set endian little
8615Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8616
8617@kindex set endian auto
8618@item set endian auto
8619Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8620executable.
8621
8622@item show endian
8623Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8624
8625@end table
8626
8627Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8628data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8629target system.
8630
6d2ebf8b 8631@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8632@section Remote debugging
8633@cindex remote debugging
8634
8635If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
8636@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8637For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
8638or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8639powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8640
8641Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8642to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 8643@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
8644but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8645write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8646communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8647
8648Other remote targets may be available in your
8649configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8650
c906108c 8651@menu
c906108c 8652* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8653@end menu
8654
6d2ebf8b 8655@node Remote Serial
104c1213 8656@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8657
104c1213
JM
8658@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8659To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8660@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8661prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8662program, you need:
c906108c 8663
104c1213
JM
8664@enumerate
8665@item
8666A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8667have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8668your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8669
5d161b24 8670@item
d4f3574e 8671A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8672subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8673
104c1213
JM
8674@item
8675A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8676download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8677manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8678documentation.
8679@end enumerate
96baa820 8680
104c1213
JM
8681The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8682communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8683machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8684
104c1213
JM
8685@table @emph
8686@item On the host,
8687@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8688else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8689(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8690
8691@item On the target,
8692you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8693implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8694subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8695
8696On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8697@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8698@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8699@end table
96baa820 8700
104c1213
JM
8701The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8702machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8703@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8704
104c1213
JM
8705@cindex remote serial stub list
8706These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8707
104c1213
JM
8708@table @code
8709
8710@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 8711@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8712@cindex Intel
8713@cindex i386
8714For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8715
8716@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 8717@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8718@cindex Motorola 680x0
8719@cindex m680x0
8720For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8721
8722@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 8723@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8724@cindex Hitachi
8725@cindex SH
8726For Hitachi SH architectures.
8727
8728@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 8729@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8730@cindex Sparc
8731For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8732
8733@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 8734@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
8735@cindex Fujitsu
8736@cindex SparcLite
8737For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8738
8739@end table
8740
8741The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8742recently added stubs.
8743
8744@menu
8745* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8746* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8747* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8748* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8749* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8750* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8751@end menu
8752
6d2ebf8b 8753@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
8754@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8755
8756@cindex remote serial stub
8757The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8758subroutines:
8759
8760@table @code
8761@item set_debug_traps
8762@kindex set_debug_traps
8763@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8764This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8765program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8766beginning of your program.
8767
8768@item handle_exception
8769@kindex handle_exception
8770@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8771This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8772explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8773run when a trap is triggered.
8774
8775@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8776execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8777with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8778protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8779representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8780information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8781retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8782execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8783@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 8784machine.
104c1213
JM
8785
8786@item breakpoint
8787@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8788Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8789breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8790way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8791machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8792pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8793@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8794simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8795again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8796your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 8797@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
8798
8799Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8800to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8801start of your debugging session.
8802@end table
8803
6d2ebf8b 8804@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
8805@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8806
8807@cindex remote stub, support routines
8808The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8809chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8810debugging target machine.
8811
8812First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8813serial port.
8814
8815@table @code
8816@item int getDebugChar()
8817@kindex getDebugChar
8818Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8819It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8820different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8821
8822@item void putDebugChar(int)
8823@kindex putDebugChar
8824Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 8825It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
8826different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8827@end table
8828
8829@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8830@cindex interrupting remote targets
8831If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8832running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8833for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8834character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8835remote system to stop.
8836
8837Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8838probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8839is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8840@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8841
8842Other routines you need to supply are:
8843
8844@table @code
8845@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8846@kindex exceptionHandler
8847Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8848handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8849way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8850are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8851containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8852@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8853its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8854might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8855exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8856@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8857and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8858you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8859should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8860
8861For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8862gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8863should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8864@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8865help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8866
8867@item void flush_i_cache()
8868@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8869On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8870instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8871instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8872
8873On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8874function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8875@end table
8876
8877@noindent
8878You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8879
8880@table @code
8881@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8882@kindex memset
8883This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8884memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8885@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8886either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8887@end table
8888
8889If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8890library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8891but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8892subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8893
8894
6d2ebf8b 8895@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
8896@subsubsection Putting it all together
8897
8898@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8899In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8900steps.
8901
8902@enumerate
8903@item
6d2ebf8b 8904Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
8905(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8906@display
8907@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8908@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8909@end display
8910
8911@item
8912Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8913
8914@example
8915set_debug_traps();
8916breakpoint();
8917@end example
8918
8919@item
8920For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8921@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8922
8923@example
8924void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8925@end example
8926
d4f3574e 8927@noindent
104c1213 8928but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 8929function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8930@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8931error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8932one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8933
8934@item
8935Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8936your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8937
8938@item
8939Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8940the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8941
8942@item
8943@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8944@c document that. FIXME.
8945Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8946whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8947
8948@item
8949To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8950as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8951This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8952of its pure text.
8953
d4f3574e 8954@item
104c1213 8955@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8956Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8957Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8958machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8959TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8960to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8961device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8962
8963@example
8964target remote /dev/ttyb
8965@end example
8966
8967@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8968To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8969@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8970terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8971
8972@example
8973target remote manyfarms:2828
8974@end example
8975@end enumerate
8976
8977Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8978step and continue the remote program.
8979
8980To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8981command.
8982
8983@cindex interrupting remote programs
8984@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8985Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8986interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8987program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8988and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8989interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8990
8991@example
8992Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8993Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8994@end example
8995
8996If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8997(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8998remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8999goes back to waiting.
9000
6d2ebf8b 9001@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
9002@subsubsection Communication protocol
9003
9004@cindex debugging stub, example
9005@cindex remote stub, example
9006@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9007The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9008communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9009@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9010these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9011implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9012with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9013organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9014
9015However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9016the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9017target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9018it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9019
9020In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9021transmitted and received data respectfully.
9022
9023@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9024@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9025@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9026All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9027sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9028@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9029@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9030
9031@example
9032@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9033@end example
9034@noindent
104c1213
JM
9035
9036@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9037@noindent
9038The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9039characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9040eight bit unsigned checksum).
9041
9042Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9043specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9044
9045@example
9046@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9047@end example
104c1213
JM
9048
9049@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9050@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9051That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9052has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9053since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9054
6cf7e474 9055@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9056When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9057response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9058the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9059retransmission):
9060
9061@example
9062<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9063-> @code{+}
9064@end example
9065@noindent
104c1213
JM
9066
9067The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9068debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9069the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9070when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9071
9072@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9073exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9074exceptions).
9075
9076Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9077@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9078HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9079
9080Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9081@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9082would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9083
9084Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9085means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9086which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9087@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9088where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9089characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9090value greater than 126 should not be used.
9091
9092Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9093loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9094character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9095
9096So:
9097@example
9098"@code{0* }"
9099@end example
9100@noindent
9101means the same as "0000".
9102
598ca718 9103The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9104error number. That number is not well defined.
9105
9106For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9107(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9108protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9109on that response.
104c1213 9110
f1251bdd
C
9111A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9112@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9113optional.
9114
104c1213
JM
9115Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9116their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9117@page
104c1213
JM
9118@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9119@item Packet
9120@tab Request
9121@tab Description
9122
f1251bdd 9123@item extended ops
104c1213
JM
9124@tab @code{!}
9125@tab
d4f3574e 9126Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
598ca718 9127The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
104c1213
JM
9128@item
9129@tab reply @samp{}
9130@tab
9131Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
9132unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
9133support protocol extensions.
9134
9135@item last signal
9136@tab @code{?}
9137@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9138Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9139and continue.
9140@item
9141@tab reply
9142@tab see below
9143
104c1213
JM
9144
9145@item reserved
9146@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9147@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9148
f1251bdd 9149@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9150@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9151@tab
598ca718
EZ
9152@item
9153@tab
9154@tab
104c1213
JM
9155Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9156specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9157See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9158@item
9159@tab reply @code{OK}
9160@item
9161@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9162
9163@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9164@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9165@tab
9166Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9167transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9168transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9169acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9170to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9171ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9172specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9173that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9174happened.}
9175
9176@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9177@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9178@tab
9179Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9180breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9181@samp{z} packets.}
9182
9183@item continue
9184@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9185@tab
9186@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9187current address.
9188@item
9189@tab reply
9190@tab see below
9191
f1251bdd 9192@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9193@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9194@tab
9195Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9196@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9197@item
9198@tab reply
9199@tab see below
9200
598ca718 9201@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9202@tab @code{d}
9203@tab
d4f3574e 9204toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9205
f1251bdd 9206@item detach
104c1213 9207@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9208@tab
2df3850c
JM
9209Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9210@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9211@item
9212@tab reply @emph{no response}
9213@tab
598ca718 9214@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9215
9216@item reserved
9217@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9218@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9219
9220@item reserved
9221@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9222@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9223
9224@item reserved
9225@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9226@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9227
9228@item reserved
9229@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9230@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9231
9232@item read registers
9233@tab @code{g}
9234@tab Read general registers.
9235@item
9236@tab reply @var{XX...}
9237@tab
9238Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9239with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9240each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9241determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9242@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9243@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9244@item
9245@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9246@tab for an error.
9247
9248@item write regs
9249@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9250@tab
9251See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9252@item
9253@tab reply @code{OK}
9254@tab for success
9255@item
9256@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9257@tab for an error
9258
9259@item reserved
9260@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9261@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9262
f1251bdd 9263@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9264@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9265@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9266Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9267@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9268continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9269thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9270@item
9271@tab reply @code{OK}
9272@tab for success
9273@item
9274@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9275@tab for an error
9276
d4f3574e
SS
9277@c FIXME: JTC:
9278@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9279@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9280@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9281@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9282@c described. For example:
9283@c
9284@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9285@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9286@c otherwise returns current registers.
9287@c
9288@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9289@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9290@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9291
f1251bdd 9292@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9293@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9294@tab
9295Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9296present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9297step starting at that address.
9298
f1251bdd 9299@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9300@tab @code{I}
9301@tab
9302See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9303
9304@item reserved
9305@tab @code{j}
9306@tab Reserved for future use
9307
9308@item reserved
9309@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9310@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9311
f1251bdd 9312@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9313@tab @code{k}
9314@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9315FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9316thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9317
9318@item reserved
9319@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9320@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9321
9322@item reserved
9323@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9324@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9325
9326@item read memory
9327@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9328@tab
9329Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9330Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9331using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9332transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9333@item
9334@tab reply @var{XX...}
9335@tab
d4f3574e 9336@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9337to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9338sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9339@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9340@item
9341@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9342@tab @var{NN} is errno
9343
9344@item write mem
9345@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9346@tab
9347Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9348@var{XX...} is the data.
9349@item
9350@tab reply @code{OK}
9351@tab for success
9352@item
9353@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9354@tab
9355for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9356written).
9357
9358@item reserved
9359@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 9360@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9361
9362@item reserved
9363@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 9364@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9365
9366@item reserved
9367@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 9368@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9369
9370@item reserved
9371@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 9372@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9373
9374@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9375@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9376@tab
9377See write register.
9378@item
9379@tab return @var{r....}
9380@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9381
f1251bdd 9382@item write reg
104c1213
JM
9383@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9384@tab
9385Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9386digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9387@item
9388@tab reply @code{OK}
9389@tab for success
9390@item
9391@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9392@tab for an error
9393
f1251bdd 9394@item general query
104c1213
JM
9395@tab @code{q}@var{query}
9396@tab
598ca718 9397Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 9398have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
9399company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9400optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9401must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
9402@item
9403@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 9404@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
9405@item
9406@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9407@tab error reply
9408@item
9409@tab reply @samp{}
9410@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9411
f1251bdd 9412@item general set
104c1213
JM
9413@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9414@tab
9415Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9416naming conventions.
9417
598ca718 9418@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
9419@tab @code{r}
9420@tab
9421Reset the entire system.
104c1213 9422
f1251bdd 9423@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
9424@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9425@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9426Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9427definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9428packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213 9429
f1251bdd 9430@item step
104c1213
JM
9431@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9432@tab
9433@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9434same address.
9435@item
9436@tab reply
9437@tab see below
9438
f1251bdd 9439@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
9440@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9441@tab
9442Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9443@item
9444@tab reply
9445@tab see below
9446
f1251bdd 9447@item search
104c1213
JM
9448@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9449@tab
9450Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9451@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9452bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 9453
f1251bdd 9454@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
9455@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9456@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9457@item
9458@tab reply @code{OK}
9459@tab thread is still alive
9460@item
9461@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9462@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 9463
104c1213
JM
9464@item reserved
9465@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 9466@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9467
9468@item reserved
9469@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 9470@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9471
9472@item reserved
9473@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 9474@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9475
9476@item reserved
9477@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 9478@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9479
9480@item reserved
9481@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 9482@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9483
9484@item reserved
9485@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 9486@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9487
9488@item reserved
9489@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 9490@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9491
f1251bdd 9492@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
9493@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9494@tab
9495@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9496binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9497escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9498@item
9499@tab reply @code{OK}
9500@tab for success
9501@item
9502@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9503@tab for an error
9504
9505@item reserved
9506@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 9507@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9508
9509@item reserved
9510@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 9511@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9512
f1251bdd 9513@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9514@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9515@tab
9516See @samp{Z}.
9517
f1251bdd 9518@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9519@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9520@tab
9521@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9522breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9523@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9524bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9525the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9526@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9527potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 9528implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
9529@item
9530@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9531@tab for an error
9532@item
9533@tab reply @code{OK}
9534@tab for success
9535@item
9536@tab @samp{}
9537@tab If not supported.
9538
9539@item reserved
9540@tab <other>
5d161b24 9541@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9542
9543@end multitable
9544
d4f3574e
SS
9545The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9546receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9547@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9548when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9549number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9550conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9551
9552@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9553
9554@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9555@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9556
9557@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9558@tab
9559@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9560(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9561by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9562thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9563starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9564@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9565extend the protocol.
9566
9567@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9568@tab
9569The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9570applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9571
9572@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9573@tab
9574The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9575
6d2ebf8b 9576@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 9577@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
9578@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
9579@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
9580@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
9581this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
9582spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
9583debugger.}
104c1213
JM
9584
9585@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9586@tab
c3f6f71d 9587@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9588while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9589for 'W', 'T', etc.
9590
9591@end multitable
9592
d4f3574e
SS
9593The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9594
9595@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9596
9597@item current thread
9598@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9599@tab Return the current thread id.
9600@item
9601@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9602@tab
9603Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9604@item
9605@tab reply *
9606@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9607
bba2971c
MS
9608@item all thread ids
9609@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9610@item
9611@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 9612@tab
bba2971c
MS
9613Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
9614may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
9615works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
9616obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 9617be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 9618sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 9619@item
bba2971c
MS
9620@tab
9621@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 9622@item
5d161b24 9623@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
9624@tab A single thread id
9625@item
00e4a2e4 9626@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
9627@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
9628@item
9629@tab reply @code{l}
9630@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
9631@item
9632@tab
9633@tab
9634In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
9635or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
9636respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
9637@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
9638(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
9639
9640@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 9641@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
9642@tab
9643@item
9644@tab
9645@tab
9646Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
9647Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
9648the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
9649thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
9650The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 9651Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
9652"Blocked on Mutex".
9653@item
9654@tab reply @var{XX...}
9655@tab
9656Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
9657printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
9658attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
9659
9660@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9661@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9662@tab
2b628194
MS
9663@item
9664@tab
9665@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9666Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9667digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9668subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9669number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9670(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9671returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9672@item
bba2971c
MS
9673@tab
9674@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9675query (see above).
9676@item
d4f3574e
SS
9677@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9678@tab
2b628194
MS
9679@item
9680@tab
9681@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9682Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9683returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9684and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9685digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9686a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9687digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9688
bba2971c
MS
9689@item compute CRC of memory block
9690@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9691@tab
9692@item
9693@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9694@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9695@item
9696@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9697@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9698
d4f3574e
SS
9699@item query sect offs
9700@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
9701@tab
9702Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9703image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9704response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9705offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
9706@item
9707@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9708
9709@item thread info request
9710@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9711@tab
598ca718
EZ
9712@item
9713@tab
9714@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9715Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9716encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9717@item
9718@tab reply *
9719@tab
9720See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9721
9722@item remote command
9723@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9724@tab
598ca718
EZ
9725@item
9726@tab
9727@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9728@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9729execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9730Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9731number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9732packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9733stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9734@item
9735@tab reply @code{OK}
9736@tab
9737A command response with no output.
9738@item
9739@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9740@tab
9741A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9742@item
9743@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9744@tab
9745Indicate a badly formed request.
9746
9747@item
9748@tab reply @samp{}
9749@tab
9750When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9751
9752@end multitable
9753
9754The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9755In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9756bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9757space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9758The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9759least-significant.
9760
9761@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9762
9763@item MIPS32
9764@tab
9765All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
976632 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9767registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9768
9769@item MIPS64
9770@tab
9771All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9772thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9773as @code{MIPS32}.
9774
9775@end multitable
9776
104c1213
JM
9777Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9778does not get any direct output:
9779
9780@example
9781<- @code{R00}
9782-> @code{+}
9783@emph{target restarts}
9784<- @code{?}
9785-> @code{+}
9786-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9787<- @code{+}
9788@end example
9789
9790Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9791
9792@example
9793<- @code{G1445...}
9794-> @code{+}
9795<- @code{s}
9796-> @code{+}
9797@emph{time passes}
9798-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9799<- @code{+}
9800<- @code{g}
9801-> @code{+}
9802-> @code{1455...}
9803<- @code{+}
9804@end example
9805
6d2ebf8b 9806@node Server
104c1213
JM
9807@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9808
9809@kindex gdbserver
9810@cindex remote connection without stubs
9811@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9812allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9813@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9814
9815@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9816because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9817that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9818@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9819@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9820because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9821also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9822started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9823Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9824the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9825do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9826by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9827choice for debugging.
9828
9829@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9830or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9831protocol.
9832
9833@table @emph
9834@item On the target machine,
9835you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9836@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9837strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9838system does all the symbol handling.
9839
9840To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9841the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9842syntax is:
9843
9844@smallexample
9845target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9846@end smallexample
9847
9848@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9849hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9850@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9851@file{/dev/com1}:
9852
9853@smallexample
9854target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9855@end smallexample
9856
9857@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9858with it.
9859
9860To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9861
9862@smallexample
9863target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9864@end smallexample
9865
9866The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9867specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9868TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9869expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9870(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9871you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9872TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9873reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9874conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9875and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9876@code{target remote} command.
9877
9878@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9879you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9880symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9881using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9882(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9883running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9884remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9885is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9886@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9887@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9888
9889@smallexample
9890(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9891@end smallexample
9892
9893@noindent
9894communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9895
9896@smallexample
9897(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9898@end smallexample
9899
9900@noindent
9901communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9902For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9903the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9904text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9905@samp{Connection refused}.
9906@end table
9907
6d2ebf8b 9908@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
9909@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9910
9911@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9912@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9913allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9914@code{target remote}.
9915
9916@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9917using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9918
9919@table @emph
9920@item On the target machine,
9921you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9922@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9923can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9924host system does all the symbol handling.
9925
9926To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9927@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9928program. The syntax is:
9929
5d161b24 9930@smallexample
104c1213
JM
9931load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9932 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9933@end smallexample
9934
9935@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9936the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9937to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9938
9939For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 9940communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9941using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9942
9943@smallexample
9944load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9945@end smallexample
9946
9947@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9948you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9949symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9950using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9951(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9952running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9953remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9954argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9955@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9956
9957@smallexample
9958(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9959@end smallexample
9960
9961@noindent
9962communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9963@end table
9964
6d2ebf8b 9965@node KOD
104c1213
JM
9966@section Kernel Object Display
9967
9968@cindex kernel object display
9969@cindex kernel object
9970@cindex KOD
9971
9972Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9973@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9974and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9975mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9976displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9977
9978Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9979@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9980
9981@example
2df3850c 9982(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
9983@end example
9984
9985If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9986about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9987which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9988after the operating system:
9989
9990@example
2df3850c 9991(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
9992List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9993Object Description
9994any Any and all objects
9995@end example
9996
9997Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9998by the kernel.
9999
10000There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
10001is supported other than to try it.
10002
10003
6d2ebf8b 10004@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
10005@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10006
10007While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10008cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10009describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10010
10011There are three major categories of configurations: native
10012configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10013operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10014different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10015are quite different from each other.
10016
10017@menu
10018* Native::
10019* Embedded OS::
10020* Embedded Processors::
10021* Architectures::
10022@end menu
10023
6d2ebf8b 10024@node Native
104c1213
JM
10025@section Native
10026
10027This section describes details specific to particular native
10028configurations.
10029
10030@menu
10031* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10032* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10033@end menu
10034
6d2ebf8b 10035@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10036@subsection HP-UX
10037
10038On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10039begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10040name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10041
6d2ebf8b 10042@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10043@subsection SVR4 process information
10044
10045@kindex /proc
10046@cindex process image
10047
10048Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10049used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10050subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10051this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10052several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10053@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10054@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10055and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10056
10057@table @code
10058@kindex info proc
10059@item info proc
10060Summarize available information about the process.
10061
10062@kindex info proc mappings
10063@item info proc mappings
10064Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10065on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10066
10067@kindex info proc times
10068@item info proc times
10069Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10070its children.
10071
10072@kindex info proc id
10073@item info proc id
10074Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10075the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10076
10077@kindex info proc status
10078@item info proc status
10079General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10080stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10081received.
10082
10083@item info proc all
10084Show all the above information about the process.
10085@end table
10086
6d2ebf8b 10087@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
10088@section Embedded Operating Systems
10089
10090This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10091embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10092architectures.
10093
10094@menu
10095* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10096@end menu
10097
10098@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10099various real-time operating systems.
10100
6d2ebf8b 10101@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
10102@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10103
10104@cindex VxWorks
10105
10106@table @code
10107
10108@kindex target vxworks
10109@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10110A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10111is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10112
10113@end table
10114
10115On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10116current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10117
10118@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10119VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10120the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10121both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 10122@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 10123installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 10124@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
10125
10126@table @code
10127@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10128@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
10129All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10130This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10131seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10132your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
10133of a thin network line.
10134@end table
10135
10136The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10137this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10138procedures.
10139
10140@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10141To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10142to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10143library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10144VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10145kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10146source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10147information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10148manual.
10149@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10150
10151Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10152your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
10153run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10154@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
10155
10156@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10157
10158@example
10159(vxgdb)
10160@end example
10161
10162@menu
10163* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10164* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10165* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10166@end menu
10167
6d2ebf8b 10168@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
10169@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10170
10171The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10172network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10173
10174@example
10175(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10176@end example
10177
10178@need 750
10179@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10180
10181@smallexample
5d161b24 10182Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
10183Connected to tt.
10184@end smallexample
10185
10186@need 1000
10187@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10188loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10189these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10190path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10191to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10192
10193@example
10194prog.o: No such file or directory.
10195@end example
10196
10197When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10198the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10199command again.
10200
6d2ebf8b 10201@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
10202@subsubsection VxWorks download
10203
10204@cindex download to VxWorks
10205If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10206object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10207@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10208incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10209command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10210to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10211table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10212the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10213filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10214Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10215to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10216the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10217@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10218and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10219program, type this on VxWorks:
10220
10221@example
10222-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10223@end example
d4f3574e
SS
10224
10225@noindent
104c1213
JM
10226Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10227
10228@example
5d161b24 10229(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
10230(vxgdb) load prog.o
10231@end example
10232
10233@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10234
10235@smallexample
10236Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10237@end smallexample
10238
10239You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10240after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10241this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10242auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10243history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 10244debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
10245table.)
10246
6d2ebf8b 10247@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
10248@subsubsection Running tasks
10249
10250@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10251You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10252follows:
10253
10254@example
10255(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10256@end example
10257
10258@noindent
10259where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10260or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10261the time of attachment.
10262
6d2ebf8b 10263@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10264@section Embedded Processors
10265
10266This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10267configurations.
10268
10269@menu
10270* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10271* ARM:: ARM
10272* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10273* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10274* i960:: Intel i960
10275* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10276* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10277* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10278* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10279* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10280* PowerPC: PowerPC
10281* SH:: Hitachi SH
10282* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10283* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10284* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10285* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10286@end menu
10287
6d2ebf8b 10288@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
10289@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10290
10291@menu
10292* A29K UDI::
10293* A29K EB29K::
10294* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10295* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10296* Remote Log:: Remote log
10297@end menu
10298
10299@table @code
10300
10301@kindex target adapt
10302@item target adapt @var{dev}
10303Adapt monitor for A29K.
10304
10305@kindex target amd-eb
10306@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10307@cindex AMD EB29K
10308Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10309@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10310@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10311name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10312@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10313
10314@end table
10315
6d2ebf8b 10316@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
10317@subsubsection A29K UDI
10318
10319@cindex UDI
10320@cindex AMD29K via UDI
10321
10322@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10323protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10324configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10325program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10326use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10327@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10328
10329@table @code
10330@item target udi @var{keyword}
10331@kindex udi
10332Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10333@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10334This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10335connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10336working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10337to its pathname.
10338@end table
10339
6d2ebf8b 10340@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
10341@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10342
10343@cindex EB29K board
10344@cindex running 29K programs
10345
10346AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10347with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10348term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10349@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10350must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10351board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10352assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10353@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10354
6d2ebf8b 10355@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
10356@subsubsection Communications setup
10357
10358The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10359in DOS on the PC:
10360
10361@example
10362C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10363@end example
10364
10365@noindent
10366This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10367bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10368you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10369end of the connection as well.
10370@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 10371@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10372@c
10373@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10374@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10375@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10376@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10377@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
10378
10379To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10380the following at the DOS console:
10381
10382@example
10383C:\> CTTY com1
10384@end example
10385
10386@noindent
10387(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10388the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 10389had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
10390
10391From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10392@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10393
10394@example
10395cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10396@end example
10397
10398@noindent
10399The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10400serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10401may look something like the following:
10402
10403@example
10404tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10405@end example
10406
10407@noindent
10408Your system may require a different name where we show
10409@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10410parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10411@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10412system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10413@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10414@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10415@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10416@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10417@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10418@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10419@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
10420@c
10421@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10422@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10423@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
10424
10425@kindex EBMON
10426Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10427directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10428start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10429with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
10430@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10431@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10432
10433@example
10434C:\> G:
10435
10436G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10437
10438G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10439Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10440Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10441Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10442
10443Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10444
10445PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
10446I/O Base = 0x208
10447Memory Base = 0xd0000
10448
10449Data Memory Size = 2048KB
10450Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10451Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10452
10453PageSize = 0x400
10454Register Stack Size = 0x800
10455Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10456
10457CPU PRL = 0x3
10458Am29027 Available = No
10459Byte Write Available = Yes
10460
10461# ~.
10462@end example
10463
10464Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10465typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10466running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10467
10468For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10469way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 10470system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
10471PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10472something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10473other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10474from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10475serial line.
10476
6d2ebf8b 10477@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
10478@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10479
10480Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10481program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10482name of your 29K program:
10483
10484@example
10485cd /usr/joe/work29k
10486@value{GDBP} myfoo
10487@end example
10488
10489@need 500
10490Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10491
10492@example
10493target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10494@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10495@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10496@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10497@end example
10498
10499@noindent
10500In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10501@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10502@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10503In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10504a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10505the name on the Unix side.
10506
10507At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10508to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10509@code{run}.
10510
10511To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10512command.
10513
10514To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10515once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10516@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10517@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10518Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10519and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10520
6d2ebf8b 10521@node Remote Log
104c1213 10522@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 10523@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
10524@cindex log file for EB29K
10525
10526The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10527current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10528@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10529of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10530another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10531unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10532
6d2ebf8b 10533@node ARM
104c1213
JM
10534@subsection ARM
10535
10536@table @code
10537
10538@kindex target rdi
10539@item target rdi @var{dev}
10540ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10541use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10542monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 10543
104c1213
JM
10544@kindex target rdp
10545@item target rdp @var{dev}
10546ARM Demon monitor.
10547
10548@end table
10549
6d2ebf8b 10550@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
10551@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10552
10553@table @code
10554
d4f3574e 10555@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10556@item target hms @var{dev}
10557A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10558Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10559line and the communications speed used.
10560
d4f3574e 10561@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10562@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10563E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10564
d4f3574e
SS
10565@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10566@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 10567@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 10568@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
10569Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10570
10571@end table
10572
10573@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10574@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10575@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10576@cindex Hitachi SH download
10577When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10578board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10579board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10580@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10581
10582@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 10583Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
10584
10585@enumerate
10586@item
10587that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10588for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10589emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 10590the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
10591H8/300, or H8/500.)
10592
10593@item
10594what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10595serial device available on your host is the default).
10596
10597@item
10598what speed to use over the serial device.
10599@end enumerate
10600
10601@menu
10602* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10603* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10604* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10605@end menu
10606
6d2ebf8b 10607@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
10608@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10609
10610@c only for Unix hosts
10611@kindex device
10612@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10613Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
10614need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10615first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10616hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10617
10618@kindex speed
10619@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 10620@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 10621speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 10622hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
10623the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10624@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10625
10626The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10627use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10628use a DOS host,
10629@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10630called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10631through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10632to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10633
10634The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10635program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10636sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10637the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10638
10639First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10640board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10641port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10642When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10643debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10644for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10645@code{COM2}.
10646
10647@example
10648C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10649C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10650
10651Resident portion of MODE loaded
10652
10653COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10654
10655@end example
10656
10657@quotation
10658@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10659@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10660disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10661your development board.
10662@end quotation
10663
d4f3574e 10664@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10665Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10666connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 10667the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
10668you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10669commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10670cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10671download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10672the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10673(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10674executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10675@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10676itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10677
10678@smallexample
10679(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 10680@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 10681 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 10682 the conditions.
5d161b24 10683There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 10684for details.
2df3850c
JM
10685@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10686(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 10687Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 10688(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
10689.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10690.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10691.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10692@end smallexample
10693
10694At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10695you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10696sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10697@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10698resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10699@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10700
10701Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10702available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10703you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10704
10705Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10706@itemize @bullet
10707@item
10708to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10709no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10710
10711@item
10712to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10713normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10714to detect program completion.
10715@end itemize
10716
10717In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10718development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10719
6d2ebf8b 10720@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
10721@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10722
d4f3574e 10723@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10724You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10725Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10726e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10727
10728@table @code
10729@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10730Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10731@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10732@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10733(for example, @samp{9600}).
10734
10735@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10736If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10737specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10738@end table
10739
6d2ebf8b 10740@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
10741@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10742
10743Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10744
10745@table @code
10746
10747@kindex set machine
10748@kindex show machine
10749@item set machine h8300
10750@itemx set machine h8300h
10751Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10752architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10753to check which variant is currently in effect.
10754
10755@end table
10756
6d2ebf8b 10757@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
10758@subsection H8/500
10759
10760@table @code
10761
10762@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10763@cindex memory models, H8/500
10764@item set memory @var{mod}
10765@itemx show memory
10766Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10767@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10768memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10769@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10770
10771@end table
10772
6d2ebf8b 10773@node i960
104c1213
JM
10774@subsection Intel i960
10775
10776@table @code
10777
10778@kindex target mon960
10779@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10780MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10781
f0ca3dce 10782@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
10783@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10784An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10785the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10786@file{/dev/ttya}.
10787
10788@end table
10789
10790@cindex Nindy
10791@cindex i960
10792@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10793@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10794tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10795
10796@itemize @bullet
10797@item
10798Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10799Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10800
10801@item
10802By responding to a prompt on startup;
10803
10804@item
10805By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10806session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10807
104c1213
JM
10808@end itemize
10809
10810@cindex download to Nindy-960
10811With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10812downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10813@value{GDBN}.
10814
10815@menu
10816* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10817* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10818* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10819@end menu
10820
6d2ebf8b 10821@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
10822@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10823
10824If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10825options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10826reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10827
10828@example
5d161b24 10829Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
10830@end example
10831
10832@noindent
10833Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10834identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10835simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10836with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10837use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10838
6d2ebf8b 10839@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
10840@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10841
10842These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10843Nindy-960 board attached:
10844
10845@table @code
10846@item -r @var{port}
10847Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10848to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10849configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10850@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10851device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10852suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10853
10854@item -O
10855(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10856the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10857This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10858target architecture.
10859
10860@quotation
10861@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10862connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10863fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10864attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10865this process with an interrupt.
10866@end quotation
10867
10868@item -brk
10869Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10870system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10871
10872@quotation
10873@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10874requires; it only works with a few boards.
10875@end quotation
10876@end table
10877
10878The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10879port.
10880
10881@c @group
6d2ebf8b 10882@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
10883@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10884
10885@table @code
10886@item reset
10887@kindex reset
10888For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10889system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10890circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10891a break is detected.
10892@end table
10893@c @end group
10894
6d2ebf8b 10895@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
10896@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10897
10898@table @code
10899
10900@kindex target m32r
10901@item target m32r @var{dev}
10902Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10903
10904@end table
10905
6d2ebf8b 10906@node M68K
104c1213
JM
10907@subsection M68k
10908
10909The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10910target command for the following ROM monitors.
10911
10912@table @code
10913
10914@kindex target abug
10915@item target abug @var{dev}
10916ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10917
10918@kindex target cpu32bug
10919@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10920CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10921
10922@kindex target dbug
10923@item target dbug @var{dev}
10924dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10925
10926@kindex target est
10927@item target est @var{dev}
10928EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10929
10930@kindex target rom68k
10931@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10932ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10933
10934@end table
10935
10936If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10937instead have only a single special target command:
10938
10939@table @code
10940
10941@kindex target es1800
10942@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10943ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10944
10945@end table
10946
10947[context?]
10948
10949@table @code
10950
10951@kindex target rombug
10952@item target rombug @var{dev}
10953ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10954
10955@end table
10956
6d2ebf8b 10957@node M88K
104c1213
JM
10958@subsection M88K
10959
10960@table @code
10961
10962@kindex target bug
10963@item target bug @var{dev}
10964BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10965
10966@end table
10967
6d2ebf8b 10968@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
10969@subsection MIPS Embedded
10970
10971@cindex MIPS boards
10972@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10973MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10974you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10975
10976@need 1000
10977Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10978
10979@table @code
10980@item target mips @var{port}
10981@kindex target mips @var{port}
10982To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10983name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10984command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10985the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10986been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10987download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10988
10989For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10990port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10991debugger:
10992
10993@example
10994host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
10995@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10996(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10997(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10998(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
10999@end example
11000
11001@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11002On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11003connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11004concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11005@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11006
11007@item target pmon @var{port}
11008@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11009PMON ROM monitor.
11010
11011@item target ddb @var{port}
11012@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11013NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11014
11015@item target lsi @var{port}
11016@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11017LSI variant of PMON.
11018
11019@kindex target r3900
11020@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11021Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11022
11023@kindex target array
11024@item target array @var{dev}
11025Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11026
11027@end table
11028
11029
11030@noindent
11031@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11032
11033@table @code
11034@item set processor @var{args}
11035@itemx show processor
11036@kindex set processor @var{args}
11037@kindex show processor
11038Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11039processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11040For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11041to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11042Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11043is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11044@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11045
11046@item set mipsfpu double
11047@itemx set mipsfpu single
11048@itemx set mipsfpu none
11049@itemx show mipsfpu
11050@kindex set mipsfpu
11051@kindex show mipsfpu
11052@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11053@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11054If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11055coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 11056need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
11057file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11058functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11059@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11060functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11061with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11062processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11063double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11064@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11065
11066In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11067floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11068and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11069
11070As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11071@samp{show mipsfpu}.
11072
11073@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11074@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
11075@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11076@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
11077@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11078@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11079@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11080@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11081You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11082by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11083@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11084to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11085at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11086
11087@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11088@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11089@itemx show timeout
11090@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11091@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11092@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11093@kindex set timeout
11094@kindex show timeout
11095@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11096@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11097You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11098remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11099default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11100waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11101retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11102You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11103retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11104@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11105
11106The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11107is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11108forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11109to run before stopping.
11110@end table
11111
6d2ebf8b 11112@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11113@subsection PowerPC
11114
11115@table @code
11116
11117@kindex target dink32
11118@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11119DINK32 ROM monitor.
11120
11121@kindex target ppcbug
11122@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11123@kindex target ppcbug1
11124@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11125PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11126
11127@kindex target sds
11128@item target sds @var{dev}
11129SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11130
11131@end table
11132
6d2ebf8b 11133@node PA
104c1213
JM
11134@subsection HP PA Embedded
11135
11136@table @code
11137
11138@kindex target op50n
11139@item target op50n @var{dev}
11140OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11141
11142@kindex target w89k
11143@item target w89k @var{dev}
11144W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11145
11146@end table
11147
6d2ebf8b 11148@node SH
104c1213
JM
11149@subsection Hitachi SH
11150
11151@table @code
11152
d4f3574e 11153@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11154@item target hms @var{dev}
11155A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11156commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11157the communications speed used.
11158
d4f3574e 11159@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11160@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11161E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11162
d4f3574e
SS
11163@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11164@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
11165@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11166@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11167Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11168
11169@end table
11170
6d2ebf8b 11171@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11172@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11173
11174@cindex Sparclet
11175
5d161b24
DB
11176@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11177Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11178@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11179both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 11180@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11181
11182@table @code
f0ca3dce 11183@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 11184@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
11185@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11186This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11187seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11188@end table
11189
41afff9a 11190@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 11191When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 11192information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 11193load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 11194@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
11195
11196@example
11197sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11198@end example
11199
d4f3574e 11200You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
11201
11202@example
11203sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11204@end example
11205
41afff9a 11206@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11207Once you have set
11208your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 11209run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
11210(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11211
11212@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11213
11214@example
11215(gdbslet)
11216@end example
11217
11218@menu
11219* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11220* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11221* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 11222* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11223@end menu
11224
6d2ebf8b 11225@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
11226@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11227
11228The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11229
11230@example
11231(gdbslet) file prog
11232@end example
11233
11234@need 1000
11235@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11236@value{GDBN} locates
11237the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11238path.
11239If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11240files will be searched as well.
11241@value{GDBN} locates
11242the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11243path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11244If it fails
11245to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11246
11247@example
11248prog: No such file or directory.
11249@end example
11250
11251When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 11252the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
11253@code{target} command again.
11254
6d2ebf8b 11255@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
11256@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11257
11258The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11259To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11260
11261@example
11262(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11263Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 11264main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
11265@end example
11266
11267@need 750
11268@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11269
d4f3574e 11270@example
104c1213 11271Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11272@end example
104c1213 11273
6d2ebf8b 11274@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
11275@subsubsection Sparclet download
11276
11277@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 11278Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
11279you can use the @value{GDBN}
11280@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11281The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11282command.
5d161b24 11283Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11284address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11285offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11286of each of the file's sections.
11287For instance, if the program
11288@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11289and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11290
11291@example
11292(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11293Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11294@end example
11295
5d161b24
DB
11296If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11297to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
11298to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11299
6d2ebf8b 11300@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
11301@subsubsection Running and debugging
11302
11303@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11304You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 11305commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
11306manual for the list of commands.
11307
11308@example
11309(gdbslet) b main
11310Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 11311(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
11312Starting program: prog
11313Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
113143 char *symarg = 0;
11315(gdbslet) step
113164 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 11317(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
11318@end example
11319
6d2ebf8b 11320@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
11321@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11322
11323@table @code
11324
11325@kindex target sparclite
11326@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
11327Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11328You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11329For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
11330remote protocol.
11331
11332@end table
11333
6d2ebf8b 11334@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
11335@subsection Tandem ST2000
11336
2df3850c 11337@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
11338STDBUG protocol.
11339
11340To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11341manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11342
11343@example
11344target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11345@end example
11346
11347@noindent
11348to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11349the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11350ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11351connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11352concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11353
11354The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11355this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11356would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11357(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11358available on your host computer.
11359@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11360@c basically hearsay.
11361
11362@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11363These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11364environment:
11365
11366@table @code
11367@item st2000 @var{command}
11368@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11369@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11370@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11371Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11372manual for available commands.
11373
11374@item connect
11375@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11376Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11377you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11378sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11379@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11380@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11381@end table
11382
6d2ebf8b 11383@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
11384@subsection Zilog Z8000
11385
11386@cindex Z8000
11387@cindex simulator, Z8000
11388@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11389
11390When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11391a Z8000 simulator.
11392
11393For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11394unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11395segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11396appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11397
11398@table @code
11399@item target sim @var{args}
11400@kindex sim
d4f3574e 11401@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
11402Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11403options, specify them via @var{args}.
11404@end table
11405
11406@noindent
11407After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11408CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11409@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11410to run your program, and so on.
11411
d4f3574e
SS
11412As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11413(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11414additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
11415
11416@table @code
11417
11418@item cycles
11419Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11420
11421@item insts
11422Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11423
11424@item time
11425Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11426
11427@end table
11428
11429You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11430conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11431conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11432simulated clock ticks.
11433
6d2ebf8b 11434@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
11435@section Architectures
11436
11437This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 11438all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
11439
11440@menu
11441* A29K::
11442* Alpha::
11443* MIPS::
11444@end menu
11445
6d2ebf8b 11446@node A29K
104c1213
JM
11447@subsection A29K
11448
11449@table @code
11450
11451@kindex set rstack_high_address
11452@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11453@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11454@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11455On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 11456@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
11457extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11458stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11459memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11460this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11461the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11462address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11463hexadecimal.
11464
11465@kindex show rstack_high_address
11466@item show rstack_high_address
11467Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11468processors.
11469
11470@end table
11471
6d2ebf8b 11472@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
11473@subsection Alpha
11474
11475See the following section.
11476
6d2ebf8b 11477@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
11478@subsection MIPS
11479
11480@cindex stack on Alpha
11481@cindex stack on MIPS
11482@cindex Alpha stack
11483@cindex MIPS stack
11484Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11485sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11486find the beginning of a function.
11487
11488@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11489To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11490@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11491you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11492commands:
11493
11494@table @code
00e4a2e4 11495@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
11496@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11497Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11498search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11499default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11500larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11501and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11502
11503@item show heuristic-fence-post
11504Display the current limit.
11505@end table
11506
11507@noindent
11508These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11509for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11510
11511
6d2ebf8b 11512@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
11513@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11514
53a5351d
JM
11515You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11516@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11517data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11518described here.
c906108c
SS
11519
11520@menu
11521* Prompt:: Prompt
11522* Editing:: Command editing
11523* History:: Command history
11524* Screen Size:: Screen size
11525* Numbers:: Numbers
11526* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 11527* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
11528@end menu
11529
6d2ebf8b 11530@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11531@section Prompt
11532
11533@cindex prompt
11534
11535@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11536called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11537can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11538instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 11539the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
11540which one you are talking to.
11541
d4f3574e 11542@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11543prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11544or a prompt that does not.
11545
11546@table @code
11547@kindex set prompt
11548@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11549Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11550
11551@kindex show prompt
11552@item show prompt
11553Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11554@end table
11555
6d2ebf8b 11556@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11557@section Command editing
11558@cindex readline
11559@cindex command line editing
11560
11561@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11562@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11563command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11564or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11565substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11566debugging sessions.
11567
11568You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11569command @code{set}.
11570
11571@table @code
11572@kindex set editing
11573@cindex editing
11574@item set editing
11575@itemx set editing on
11576Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11577
11578@item set editing off
11579Disable command line editing.
11580
11581@kindex show editing
11582@item show editing
11583Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11584@end table
11585
6d2ebf8b 11586@node History
c906108c
SS
11587@section Command history
11588
11589@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11590debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11591happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11592history facility.
11593
11594@table @code
11595@cindex history substitution
11596@cindex history file
11597@kindex set history filename
11598@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11599@item set history filename @var{fname}
11600Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11601This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11602list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11603exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11604the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11605to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11606@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11607is not set.
c906108c
SS
11608
11609@cindex history save
11610@kindex set history save
11611@item set history save
11612@itemx set history save on
11613Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11614@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11615
11616@item set history save off
11617Stop recording command history in a file.
11618
11619@cindex history size
11620@kindex set history size
11621@item set history size @var{size}
11622Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11623This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11624@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11625@end table
11626
11627@cindex history expansion
11628History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11629@ifset have-readline-appendices
11630@xref{Event Designators}.
11631@end ifset
11632
11633Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11634is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11635@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11636follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11637a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11638history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11639@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11640
11641The commands to control history expansion are:
11642
11643@table @code
11644@kindex set history expansion
11645@item set history expansion on
11646@itemx set history expansion
11647Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11648
11649@item set history expansion off
11650Disable history expansion.
11651
11652The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11653editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11654or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11655@ifset have-readline-appendices
11656@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11657@end ifset
11658
11659@c @group
11660@kindex show history
11661@item show history
11662@itemx show history filename
11663@itemx show history save
11664@itemx show history size
11665@itemx show history expansion
11666These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11667@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11668@c @end group
11669@end table
11670
11671@table @code
41afff9a 11672@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
11673@item show commands
11674Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11675
11676@item show commands @var{n}
11677Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11678
11679@item show commands +
11680Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11681@end table
11682
6d2ebf8b 11683@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11684@section Screen size
11685@cindex size of screen
11686@cindex pauses in output
11687
11688Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11689information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11690@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11691output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11692to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11693determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11694printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11695rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11696
d4f3574e
SS
11697Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11698driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11699together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11700@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11701you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11702width} commands:
11703
11704@table @code
11705@kindex set height
11706@kindex set width
11707@kindex show width
11708@kindex show height
11709@item set height @var{lpp}
11710@itemx show height
11711@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11712@itemx show width
11713These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11714a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11715commands display the current settings.
11716
5d161b24
DB
11717If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11718output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
11719file or to an editor buffer.
11720
11721Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11722from wrapping its output.
11723@end table
11724
6d2ebf8b 11725@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11726@section Numbers
11727@cindex number representation
11728@cindex entering numbers
11729
2df3850c
JM
11730You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11731@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11732@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11733begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11734default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11735numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11736change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11737radix} command.
c906108c
SS
11738
11739@table @code
11740@kindex set input-radix
11741@item set input-radix @var{base}
11742Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11743for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11744specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11745example, any of
11746
11747@smallexample
11748set radix 012
11749set radix 10.
11750set radix 0xa
11751@end smallexample
11752
11753@noindent
11754sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11755leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11756
11757@kindex set output-radix
11758@item set output-radix @var{base}
11759Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11760for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11761specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11762
11763@kindex show input-radix
11764@item show input-radix
11765Display the current default base for numeric input.
11766
11767@kindex show output-radix
11768@item show output-radix
11769Display the current default base for numeric display.
11770@end table
11771
6d2ebf8b 11772@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11773@section Optional warnings and messages
11774
2df3850c
JM
11775By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11776running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11777command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11778internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
11779
11780Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11781which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11782see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11783
11784@table @code
11785@kindex set verbose
11786@item set verbose on
11787Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11788
11789@item set verbose off
11790Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11791
11792@kindex show verbose
11793@item show verbose
11794Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11795@end table
11796
2df3850c
JM
11797By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11798object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11799find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11800symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
11801
11802@table @code
2df3850c 11803
c906108c
SS
11804@kindex set complaints
11805@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
11806Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11807unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11808@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11809to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
11810
11811@kindex show complaints
11812@item show complaints
11813Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 11814
c906108c
SS
11815@end table
11816
11817By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11818lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11819you try to run a program which is already running:
11820
11821@example
11822(@value{GDBP}) run
11823The program being debugged has been started already.
11824Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11825@end example
11826
11827If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11828commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11829
11830@table @code
2df3850c 11831
c906108c
SS
11832@kindex set confirm
11833@cindex flinching
11834@cindex confirmation
11835@cindex stupid questions
11836@item set confirm off
11837Disables confirmation requests.
11838
11839@item set confirm on
11840Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11841
11842@kindex show confirm
11843@item show confirm
11844Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 11845
c906108c
SS
11846@end table
11847
6d2ebf8b 11848@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
11849@section Optional messages about internal happenings
11850@table @code
11851@kindex set debug arch
11852@item set debug arch
11853Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
11854@kindex show debug arch
11855@item show debug arch
11856Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
11857@kindex set debug event
11858@item set debug event
11859Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
11860default is off.
11861@kindex show debug event
11862@item show debug event
11863Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
11864info.
11865@kindex set debug expression
11866@item set debug expression
11867Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
11868default is off.
11869@kindex show debug expression
11870@item show debug expression
11871Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
11872debugging info.
11873@kindex set debug overload
11874@item set debug overload
11875Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C++ overload debugging
11876info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
11877is off.
11878@kindex show debug overload
11879@item show debug overload
11880Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C++ overload
11881debugging info.
11882@kindex set debug remote
11883@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
11884@cindex serial connections, debugging
11885@item set debug remote
11886Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
11887the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
11888@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
11889@kindex show debug remote
11890@item show debug remote
11891Displays the state of display of remote packets.
11892@kindex set debug serial
11893@item set debug serial
11894Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
11895default is off.
11896@kindex show debug serial
11897@item show debug serial
11898Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
11899info.
11900@kindex set debug target
11901@item set debug target
11902Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
11903includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
11904default is off.
11905@kindex show debug target
11906@item show debug target
11907Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
11908info.
11909@kindex set debug varobj
11910@item set debug varobj
11911Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
11912info. The default is off.
11913@kindex show debug varobj
11914@item show debug varobj
11915Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
11916debugging info.
11917@end table
11918
6d2ebf8b 11919@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11920@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11921
11922Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
11923command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11924commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11925files.
c906108c
SS
11926
11927@menu
11928* Define:: User-defined commands
11929* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11930* Command Files:: Command files
11931* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11932@end menu
11933
6d2ebf8b 11934@node Define
c906108c
SS
11935@section User-defined commands
11936
11937@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
11938A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11939which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11940@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11941separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11942via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
11943
11944@smallexample
11945define adder
11946 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11947@end smallexample
11948
d4f3574e
SS
11949@noindent
11950To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11951
11952@smallexample
11953adder 1 2 3
11954@end smallexample
11955
d4f3574e
SS
11956@noindent
11957This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 11958its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
11959reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11960functions calls.
11961
11962@table @code
2df3850c 11963
c906108c
SS
11964@kindex define
11965@item define @var{commandname}
11966Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11967by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11968
11969The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11970which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11971commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11972
11973@kindex if
11974@kindex else
11975@item if
11976Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11977It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11978only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11979There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11980by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11981was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11982
11983@kindex while
11984@item while
11985The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11986which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11987execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11988The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11989evaluates to true.
11990
11991@kindex document
11992@item document @var{commandname}
11993Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
11994accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11995defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11996reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11997After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
11998@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11999
12000You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12001documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12002does not change the documentation.
12003
12004@kindex help user-defined
12005@item help user-defined
12006List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12007(if any) for each.
12008
12009@kindex show user
12010@item show user
12011@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
12012Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12013not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 12014definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 12015
c906108c
SS
12016@end table
12017
12018When user-defined commands are executed, the
12019commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12020stops execution of the user-defined command.
12021
12022If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12023without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12024commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12025messages when used in a user-defined command.
12026
6d2ebf8b 12027@node Hooks
c906108c 12028@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12029@cindex command hooks
12030@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12031@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12032
c78b4128
EZ
12033@kindex hook
12034@kindex hook-
12035You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12036command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12037command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12038before that command.
12039
c78b4128
EZ
12040@cindex hooks, post-command
12041@kindex hookpost
12042@kindex hookpost-
12043A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12044Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12045@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12046that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12047pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12048
12049It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12050occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12051
12052@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12053@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12054
d4f3574e 12055@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
12056In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12057(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12058execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12059displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12060
c906108c
SS
12061For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12062single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12063you could define:
12064
12065@example
12066define hook-stop
12067handle SIGALRM nopass
12068end
12069
12070define hook-run
12071handle SIGALRM pass
12072end
12073
12074define hook-continue
12075handle SIGLARM pass
12076end
12077@end example
c906108c 12078
c78b4128
EZ
12079As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12080command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12081you could define:
12082
12083@example
12084define hook-echo
12085echo <<<---
12086end
12087
12088define hookpost-echo
12089echo --->>>\n
12090end
12091
12092(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12093<<<---Hello World--->>>
12094(@value{GDBP})
12095
12096@end example
12097
c906108c
SS
12098You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12099not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12100name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12101@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12102@c or not?
12103If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12104@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12105(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12106
12107If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12108get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12109
6d2ebf8b 12110@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
12111@section Command files
12112
12113@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
12114A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12115commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12116An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
12117the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12118
12119@cindex init file
12120@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 12121@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 12122When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
12123@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12124@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12125following:
12126
12127@enumerate
12128@item
12129Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12130DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12131@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12132
12133@item
12134Processes command line options and operands.
12135
12136@item
12137Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12138
12139@item
12140Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12141@end enumerate
12142
12143The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12144complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12145and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12146option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12147
c906108c
SS
12148@cindex init file name
12149On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12150different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12151form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12152different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12153environments with special init file names:
12154
00e4a2e4 12155@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
12156@itemize @bullet
12157@item
00e4a2e4 12158VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12159
00e4a2e4 12160@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12161@item
00e4a2e4 12162OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12163
00e4a2e4 12164@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12165@item
00e4a2e4 12166ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12167@end itemize
c906108c
SS
12168
12169You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12170@code{source} command:
12171
12172@table @code
12173@kindex source
12174@item source @var{filename}
12175Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12176@end table
12177
12178The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12179printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12180of the command file.
12181
12182Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12183without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12184normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12185when called from command files.
12186
6d2ebf8b 12187@node Output
c906108c
SS
12188@section Commands for controlled output
12189
12190During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12191@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12192explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12193describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12194want.
12195
12196@table @code
12197@kindex echo
12198@item echo @var{text}
12199@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12200@c because it is not in ANSI.
12201Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12202@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12203newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12204In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12205by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12206string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 12207trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
12208To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12209@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12210
12211A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12212the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12213
12214@example
12215echo This is some text\n\
12216which is continued\n\
12217onto several lines.\n
12218@end example
12219
12220produces the same output as
12221
12222@example
12223echo This is some text\n
12224echo which is continued\n
12225echo onto several lines.\n
12226@end example
12227
12228@kindex output
12229@item output @var{expression}
12230Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12231newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 12232value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
12233on expressions.
12234
12235@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12236Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12237the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12238formats}, for more information.
12239
12240@kindex printf
12241@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12242Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12243@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12244either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12245@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12246subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
12247@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12248@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12249@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12250@c supported.
c906108c
SS
12251
12252@example
12253printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12254@end example
12255
12256For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12257
12258@smallexample
12259printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12260@end smallexample
12261
12262The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12263string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12264letter.
12265@end table
12266
6d2ebf8b 12267@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
12268@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12269
12270@cindex Emacs
12271@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12272A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12273edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12274@value{GDBN}.
12275
12276To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12277executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12278@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12279created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 12280@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
12281
12282Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12283things:
12284
12285@itemize @bullet
12286@item
12287All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12288@end itemize
12289
12290This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12291and output done by the program you are debugging.
12292
12293This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12294commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12295in this way.
12296
12297All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12298with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
12299way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12300stop.
12301
12302@itemize @bullet
12303@item
12304@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12305@end itemize
12306
12307Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12308source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12309left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12310source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12311and the source.
12312
12313Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12314usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12315
12316@quotation
12317@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12318current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12319the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12320appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12321environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12322session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12323back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
12324avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12325your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12326@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12327
12328A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12329switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12330@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12331@end quotation
12332
12333By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
12334you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12335several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12336Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12337
12338@example
12339(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12340@end example
12341
12342@noindent
d4f3574e 12343(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
12344in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12345``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12346
12347In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
12348addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
12349
12350@table @kbd
12351@item C-h m
12352Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
12353
12354@item M-s
12355Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
12356update the display window to show the current file and location.
12357
12358@item M-n
12359Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
12360calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
12361to show the current file and location.
12362
12363@item M-i
12364Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
12365display window accordingly.
12366
12367@item M-x gdb-nexti
12368Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
12369display window accordingly.
12370
12371@item C-c C-f
12372Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
12373@code{finish} command.
12374
12375@item M-c
12376Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
12377command.
12378
12379@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
12380
12381@item M-u
12382Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
12383(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
12384like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
12385
12386@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
12387
12388@item M-d
12389Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
12390@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
12391
12392@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
12393
12394@item C-x &
12395Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
12396of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
12397around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
12398then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
12399argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
12400
12401You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
12402@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
12403otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
12404inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
12405wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
12406list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
12407formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
12408is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
12409@end table
12410
12411In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
12412tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
12413
12414If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
12415it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
12416request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
12417the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
12418frame.
12419
12420The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
12421which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
12422the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
12423communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
12424delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
12425to correspond properly with the code.
12426
12427@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
12428@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
12429@ignore
12430@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
12431@kindex Epoch
12432@kindex inspect
12433
5d161b24 12434Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
12435called the @code{epoch}
12436environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
12437@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
12438each value is printed in its own window.
12439@end ignore
c906108c 12440
d700128c 12441@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 12442@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 12443
6d2ebf8b 12444@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
12445@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
12446@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
12447@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
12448
12449Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
12450
12451Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
12452may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
12453the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
12454reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
12455
12456In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
12457information that enables us to fix the bug.
12458
12459@menu
12460* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
12461* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
12462@end menu
12463
6d2ebf8b 12464@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
12465@section Have you found a bug?
12466@cindex bug criteria
12467
12468If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12469
12470@itemize @bullet
12471@cindex fatal signal
12472@cindex debugger crash
12473@cindex crash of debugger
12474@item
12475If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12476@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
12477
12478@cindex error on valid input
12479@item
12480If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12481bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12482somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12483
12484@cindex invalid input
12485@item
12486If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12487that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
12488``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12489for traditional practice''.
12490
12491@item
12492If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12493for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12494@end itemize
12495
6d2ebf8b 12496@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
12497@section How to report bugs
12498@cindex bug reports
12499@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12500
c906108c
SS
12501A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12502If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12503contact that organization first.
12504
12505You can find contact information for many support companies and
12506individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12507distribution.
12508@c should add a web page ref...
12509
12510In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12511@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12512
12513@example
d4f3574e 12514bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
12515@end example
12516
12517@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 12518@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
12519not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
12520@samp{bug-gdb}.
12521
12522The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12523serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12524the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12525newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
12526problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12527path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12528we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
12529bug reports to the mailing list.
12530
12531As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12532
12533@example
12534@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12535Free Software Foundation Inc.
1253659 Temple Place - Suite 330
12537Boston, MA 02111-1307
12538USA
12539@end example
c906108c
SS
12540
12541The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12542@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
12543fact or leave it out, state it!
12544
12545Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12546problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
12547assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12548Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
12549stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12550name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12551of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12552the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
12553easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12554
12555Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12556bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12557you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12558self-contained.
12559
12560Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12561bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12562@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12563bugs properly.
12564
12565To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12566
12567@itemize @bullet
12568@item
12569The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12570with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12571version}.
12572
12573Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12574the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12575
12576@item
12577The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12578version number.
12579
c906108c
SS
12580@item
12581What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12582``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
12583
12584@item
12585What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12586debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12587C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12588information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12589compilers.
12590
12591@item
12592The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12593observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12594you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12595Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12596
12597If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12598and then we might not encounter the bug.
12599
12600@item
12601A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12602reproduce the bug.
12603
12604@item
12605A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12606incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12607
12608Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12609will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12610not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12611a chance to make a mistake.
12612
12613Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12614say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12615copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12616the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12617crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12618ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12619us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12620to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12621
c906108c
SS
12622@item
12623If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12624diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12625it by context, not by line number.
12626
12627The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12628sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 12629
c906108c
SS
12630@end itemize
12631
12632Here are some things that are not necessary:
12633
12634@itemize @bullet
12635@item
12636A description of the envelope of the bug.
12637
12638Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12639which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12640changes will not affect it.
12641
12642This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12643will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12644with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12645We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12646
12647Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12648of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12649output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12650less time, and so on.
12651
12652However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12653report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12654
12655@item
12656A patch for the bug.
12657
12658A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12659the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12660a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12661to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12662
12663Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12664construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12665through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12666to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12667
12668And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12669patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12670help us to understand.
12671
12672@item
12673A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12674
12675Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12676things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12677@end itemize
12678
5d161b24 12679@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
12680@c and consists of the two following files:
12681@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12682@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12683@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12684@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12685@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12686@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12687
12688
6d2ebf8b 12689@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12690@appendix Formatting Documentation
12691
12692@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12693@cindex reference card
12694The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12695for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12696subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12697@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12698release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12699you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12700
12701The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12702can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12703
12704@example
12705make refcard.dvi
12706@end example
12707
5d161b24
DB
12708The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12709mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
12710that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12711high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12712your @sc{dvi} output program.
12713
12714@cindex documentation
12715
12716All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12717distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12718a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12719on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12720formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12721and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12722
12723@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12724version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12725file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12726subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12727necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12728but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12729Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12730@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12731
12732If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12733Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12734@code{makeinfo}.
12735
12736If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12737@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12738version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12739
12740@example
12741cd gdb
12742make gdb.info
12743@end example
12744
12745If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12746a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12747Texinfo definitions file.
12748
12749@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12750produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12751document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12752has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12753command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12754(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12755require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12756
12757@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12758@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12759written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12760typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12761and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12762directory.
12763
12764If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12765typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12766subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12767@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12768
12769@example
12770make gdb.dvi
12771@end example
12772
12773Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12774
6d2ebf8b 12775@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12776@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12777@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12778@cindex installation
12779
c906108c
SS
12780@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12781of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12782build the @code{gdb} program.
12783@iftex
12784@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12785@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12786look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12787installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12788@end iftex
12789
5d161b24
DB
12790The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12791@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
12792appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12793
12794For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12795@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12796
12797@table @code
12798@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12799script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12800
12801@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12802the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12803
12804@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12805source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12806
12807@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12808@sc{gnu} include files
12809
12810@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12811source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12812
12813@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12814source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12815
12816@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12817source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12818
12819@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12820source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12821
12822@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12823source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12824@end table
12825
12826The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12827from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12828this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12829
12830First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12831if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12832identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12833argument.
12834
12835For example:
12836
12837@example
12838cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12839./configure @var{host}
12840make
12841@end example
12842
12843@noindent
12844where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12845@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12846(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12847correct value by examining your system.)
12848
12849Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12850@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12851libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12852binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12853
12854@need 750
12855@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12856system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12857shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12858
12859@example
12860sh configure @var{host}
12861@end example
12862
12863If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12864directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12865@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12866creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12867you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12868
12869You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12870subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12871configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12872
12873For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12874the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12875
12876@example
12877@group
12878cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12879../configure @var{host}
12880@end group
12881@end example
12882
12883You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12884However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12885the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12886that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12887let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12888
12889@menu
12890* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12891* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12892* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12893@end menu
12894
6d2ebf8b 12895@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12896@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12897
12898If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12899you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12900host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12901allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12902rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12903handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12904@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12905program specified there.
12906
12907To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12908with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12909(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12910itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12911would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12912the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12913
5d161b24 12914For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
12915separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12916
12917@example
12918@group
12919cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12920mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12921cd ../gdb-sun4
12922../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12923make
12924@end group
12925@end example
12926
12927When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12928directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12929(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12930the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12931directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12932@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12933
12934One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
12935directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12936@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12937programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
12938You specify a cross-debugging target by
12939giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12940
12941When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12942it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12943called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12944
12945The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12946directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12947directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12948directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12949will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12950
12951When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12952directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12953if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12954with each other.
12955
6d2ebf8b 12956@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12957@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12958
12959The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12960script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12961aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12962of information in the following pattern:
12963
12964@example
12965@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12966@end example
12967
12968For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12969or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12970option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12971
12972The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12973any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12974aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12975@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12976script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12977abbreviations---for example:
12978
12979@smallexample
12980% sh config.sub i386-linux
12981i386-pc-linux-gnu
12982% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12983alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12984% sh config.sub hp9k700
12985hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12986% sh config.sub sun4
12987sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12988% sh config.sub sun3
12989m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12990% sh config.sub i986v
12991Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12992@end smallexample
12993
12994@noindent
12995@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12996directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12997
6d2ebf8b 12998@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12999@section @code{configure} options
13000
13001Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13002are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13003several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13004Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13005
13006@example
13007configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13008 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13009 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13010 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13011 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13012 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13013 @var{host}
13014@end example
13015
13016@noindent
13017You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13018@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13019@samp{--}.
13020
13021@table @code
13022@item --help
13023Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13024
13025@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13026Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13027@file{@var{dir}}.
13028
13029@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13030Configure the source to install programs under directory
13031@file{@var{dir}}.
13032
13033@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13034@need 2000
13035@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13036@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13037@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13038Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13039@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13040build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13041directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13042the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13043directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13044the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13045@var{dirname}.
13046
13047@item --norecursion
13048Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13049propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13050
13051@item --target=@var{target}
13052Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13053@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13054programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13055
13056There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13057
13058@item @var{host} @dots{}
13059Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13060
13061There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13062@end table
13063
13064There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13065needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 13066
6d2ebf8b 13067@node Index
c906108c
SS
13068@unnumbered Index
13069
13070@printindex cp
13071
13072@tex
13073% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13074% meantime:
13075\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13076\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13077\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13078\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13079\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13080\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13081\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13082\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13083\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13084\page\colophon
13085% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13086@end tex
13087
449f3b6c
AC
13088@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13089@ifinfo
c906108c 13090@contents
449f3b6c
AC
13091@end ifinfo
13092@ifhtml
13093@contents
13094@end ifhtml
13095
c906108c 13096@bye